71c35ad7871ed738d7e5709775aca49da4944b6c
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf32-ppc.c
1 /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
2 Copyright (C) 1994-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the
19 Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /* This file is based on a preliminary PowerPC ELF ABI. The
24 information may not match the final PowerPC ELF ABI. It includes
25 suggestions from the in-progress Embedded PowerPC ABI, and that
26 information may also not match. */
27
28 #include "sysdep.h"
29 #include <stdarg.h>
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "bfdlink.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "elf-bfd.h"
34 #include "elf/ppc.h"
35 #include "elf32-ppc.h"
36 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
37 #include "dwarf2.h"
38 #include "opcode/ppc.h"
39
40 /* All users of this file have bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) == 1. */
41 #define OCTETS_PER_BYTE(ABFD, SEC) 1
42
43 typedef enum split16_format_type
44 {
45 split16a_type = 0,
46 split16d_type
47 }
48 split16_format_type;
49
50 /* RELA relocations are used here. */
51
52 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
53 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
54 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
55 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
56
57 /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs. */
58 #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
59 /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions. */
60 #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
61 /* Value to shift register by to insert RA. */
62 #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
63
64 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
65 section. */
66 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
67
68 /* For old-style PLT. */
69 /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots). */
70 #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
71
72 /* For new-style .glink and .plt. */
73 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
74 #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h) \
75 ((4*4 \
76 + (h != NULL \
77 && h == htab->tls_get_addr \
78 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0) \
79 + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1) \
80 & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
81
82 /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker. */
83
84 /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry. */
85 #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
86 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
87 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
88 {
89 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
90 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
91 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
92 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
93 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
94 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
95 0x60000000, /* nop */
96 0x60000000, /* nop */
97 };
98 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
99 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
100 {
101 0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
102 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
103 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
104 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
105 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
106 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
107 0x60000000, /* nop */
108 0x60000000, /* nop */
109 };
110
111 /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry. */
112 #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
113 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
114 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
115 {
116 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
117 0x398c0000, /* addi r12,r12,0 */
118 0x800c0008, /* lwz r0,8(r12) */
119 0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr r0 */
120 0x818c0004, /* lwz r12,4(r12) */
121 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
122 0x60000000, /* nop */
123 0x60000000, /* nop */
124 };
125 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
126 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
127 {
128 0x819e0008, /* lwz r12,8(r30) */
129 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
130 0x819e0004, /* lwz r12,4(r30) */
131 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
132 0x60000000, /* nop */
133 0x60000000, /* nop */
134 0x60000000, /* nop */
135 0x60000000, /* nop */
136 };
137
138 /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
139 .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader. */
140
141 /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
142 #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
143 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
144 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
145 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
146 a shared library. */
147 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
148
149 /* Some instructions. */
150 #define ADDIS_11_11 0x3d6b0000
151 #define ADDIS_11_30 0x3d7e0000
152 #define ADDIS_12_12 0x3d8c0000
153 #define ADDI_11_11 0x396b0000
154 #define ADD_0_11_11 0x7c0b5a14
155 #define ADD_3_12_2 0x7c6c1214
156 #define ADD_11_0_11 0x7d605a14
157 #define B 0x48000000
158 #define BA 0x48000002
159 #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005
160 #define BCTR 0x4e800420
161 #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
162 #define CMPWI_11_0 0x2c0b0000
163 #define LIS_11 0x3d600000
164 #define LIS_12 0x3d800000
165 #define LWZU_0_12 0x840c0000
166 #define LWZ_0_12 0x800c0000
167 #define LWZ_11_3 0x81630000
168 #define LWZ_11_11 0x816b0000
169 #define LWZ_11_30 0x817e0000
170 #define LWZ_12_3 0x81830000
171 #define LWZ_12_12 0x818c0000
172 #define MR_0_3 0x7c601b78
173 #define MR_3_0 0x7c030378
174 #define MFLR_0 0x7c0802a6
175 #define MFLR_12 0x7d8802a6
176 #define MTCTR_0 0x7c0903a6
177 #define MTCTR_11 0x7d6903a6
178 #define MTLR_0 0x7c0803a6
179 #define NOP 0x60000000
180 #define SUB_11_11_12 0x7d6c5850
181
182 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
183 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
184 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
185
186 /* The value of a defined global symbol. */
187 #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
188 ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma \
189 + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset \
190 + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
191 \f
192 /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
193 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
194 field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
195 always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
196 PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
197 the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
198 and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
199 rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
200 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
201 complain, special_func) \
202 HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
203 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
204 #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
205
206 static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
207
208 static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
209 /* This reloc does nothing. */
210 HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
211 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
212
213 /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
214 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
215 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
216
217 /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
218 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
219 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
220 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
221
222 /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
223 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
224 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
225
226 /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
227 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
228 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
229
230 /* The high order 16 bits of an address. */
231 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
232 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
233
234 /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
235 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
236 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
237 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
238
239 /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
240 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
241 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
242 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
243
244 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
245 indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
246 bits must be zero. */
247 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
248 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
249
250 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
251 indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
252 two bits must be zero. */
253 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
254 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
255
256 /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
257 HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
258 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
259
260 /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
261 HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
262 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
263
264 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
265 the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
266 zero. */
267 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
268 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
269
270 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
271 the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
272 be zero. */
273 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
274 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
275
276 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
277 symbol. */
278 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
279 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
280
281 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
282 the symbol. */
283 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
284 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
285
286 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
287 the symbol. */
288 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
289 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
290
291 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
292 the symbol. */
293 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
294 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
295
296 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
297 entry for the symbol. */
298 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
299 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
300
301 /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
302 both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
303 dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
304 shared library into the object, because the object being
305 run has to have the data at some particular address. */
306 HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
307 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
308
309 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
310 entries. */
311 HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
312 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
313
314 /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol. */
315 HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
316 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
317
318 /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
319 longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
320 addend. */
321 HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
322 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
323
324 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
325 object rather than the final value. Normally used for
326 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
327 HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
328 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
329
330 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
331 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
332 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
333
334 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
335 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
336 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
337
338 /* 32-bit PC relative */
339 HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
340 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
341
342 /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
343 FIXME: not supported. */
344 HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
345 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
346
347 /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
348 FIXME: not supported. */
349 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0, 0, TRUE, dont,
350 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
351
352 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
353 the symbol. */
354 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
355 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
356
357 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
358 the symbol. */
359 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
360 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
361
362 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
363 the symbol. */
364 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
365 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
366
367 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
368 small data items. */
369 HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
370 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
371
372 /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
373 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
374 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
375
376 /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation. */
377 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
378 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
379
380 /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
381 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
382 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
383
384 /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
385 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
386 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
387
388 /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
389 HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
390 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
391
392 HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
393 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
394
395 HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
396 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
397
398 /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
399 HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
400 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
401
402 HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
403 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
404
405 /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
406 definition of its TLS sym. */
407 HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
408 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
409
410 /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
411 of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
412 contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
413 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
414 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
415
416 /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
417 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
418 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
419
420 /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
421 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
422 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
423
424 /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
425 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
426 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
427
428 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
429 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
430 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
431
432 /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
433 sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
434 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
435 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
436
437 /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
438 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
439 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
440
441 /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
442 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
443 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
444
445 /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
446 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
447 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
448
449 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
450 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
451 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
452
453 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
454 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
455 to the first entry. */
456 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
457 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
458
459 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
460 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
461 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
462
463 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
464 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
465 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
466
467 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
468 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
469 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
470
471 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
472 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
473 first entry. */
474 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
475 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
476
477 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
478 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
479 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
480
481 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
482 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
483 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
484
485 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
486 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
487 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
488
489 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
490 the offset to the entry. */
491 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
492 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
493
494 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
495 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
496 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
497
498 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
499 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
500 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
501
502 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
503 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
504 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
505
506 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
507 offset to the entry. */
508 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
509 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
510
511 /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow. */
512 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
513 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
514
515 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
516 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
517 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
518
519 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
520 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
521 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
522
523 /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
524 in the SVR4 ELF ABI. */
525
526 /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
527 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
528 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
529
530 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
531 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
532 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
533
534 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
535 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
536 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
537
538 /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol. */
539 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
540 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
541
542 /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
543 plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
544 is negative. */
545 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
546 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
547
548 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
549 address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
550 _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation. */
551 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
552 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
553
554 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
555 address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
556 _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation. */
557 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
558 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
559
560 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
561 small data items. */
562 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
563 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
564
565 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
566 signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
567 field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
568 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
569 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
570
571 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
572 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
573 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
574 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
575 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
576 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
577
578 /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
579 in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
580 register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
581 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
582 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
583
584 /* A relative 8 bit branch. */
585 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 1, 8, 0xff, 1, TRUE, signed,
586 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
587
588 /* A relative 15 bit branch. */
589 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 2, 16, 0xfffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
590 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
591
592 /* A relative 24 bit branch. */
593 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 2, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
594 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
595
596 /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format. */
597 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
598 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
599
600 /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format. */
601 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
602 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
603
604 /* Bits 16-31 split16a format. */
605 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
606 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
607
608 /* Bits 16-31 split16d format. */
609 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
610 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
611
612 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format. */
613 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
614 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
615
616 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format. */
617 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
618 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
619
620 /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
621 instructions. If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
622 the e_add16i to an e_li instruction. */
623 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
624 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
625
626 /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow. */
627 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
628 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
629
630 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
631 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
632 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
633
634 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
635 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
636 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
637
638 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
639 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
640 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
641
642 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
643 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
644 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
645
646 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format. */
647 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
648 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
649
650 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format. */
651 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
652 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
653
654 /* e_li split20 format. */
655 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 2, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, FALSE, dont,
656 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
657
658 HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
659 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
660
661 /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
662 HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
663 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
664
665 /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
666 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
667 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
668
669 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
670 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
671 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
672
673 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
674 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
675 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
676 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
677
678 /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
679 HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
680 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
681
682 /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
683 HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
684 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
685
686 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
687 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
688 NULL),
689
690 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
691 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
692 NULL),
693
694 /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries. */
695 HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
696 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
697 };
698 \f
699 /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done. */
700
701 static void
702 ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
703 {
704 unsigned int i, type;
705
706 for (i = 0;
707 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
708 i++)
709 {
710 type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
711 if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
712 / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
713 abort ();
714 ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
715 }
716 }
717
718 static reloc_howto_type *
719 ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
720 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
721 {
722 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
723
724 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
725 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
726 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
727
728 switch (code)
729 {
730 default:
731 return NULL;
732
733 case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC_NONE; break;
734 case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
735 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC_ADDR24; break;
736 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
737 case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16; break;
738 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
739 case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO; break;
740 case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI; break;
741 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA; break;
742 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC_ADDR14; break;
743 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN; break;
744 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN; break;
745 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC_REL24; break;
746 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC_REL14; break;
747 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN; break;
748 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN; break;
749 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
750 case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16; break;
751 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
752 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO; break;
753 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI; break;
754 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA; break;
755 case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL24; break;
756 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC_COPY; break;
757 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT; break;
758 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC: r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC; break;
759 case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL32; break;
760 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT32; break;
761 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL32; break;
762 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
763 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO; break;
764 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI; break;
765 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA; break;
766 case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16: r = R_PPC_SDAREL16; break;
767 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
768 case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF; break;
769 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
770 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO; break;
771 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI; break;
772 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA; break;
773 case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
774 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
775 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC_TOC16; break;
776 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC_TLS; break;
777 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC_TLSGD; break;
778 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC_TLSLD; break;
779 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32; break;
780 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
781 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_TPREL16; break;
782 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
783 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; break;
784 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI; break;
785 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; break;
786 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC_TPREL32; break;
787 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
788 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16; break;
789 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
790 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO; break;
791 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI; break;
792 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA; break;
793 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC_DTPREL32; break;
794 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16; break;
795 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO; break;
796 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI; break;
797 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA; break;
798 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16; break;
799 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO; break;
800 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI; break;
801 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA; break;
802 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16; break;
803 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO; break;
804 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI; break;
805 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA; break;
806 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16; break;
807 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO; break;
808 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI; break;
809 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA; break;
810 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32; break;
811 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16; break;
812 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO; break;
813 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI; break;
814 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA; break;
815 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16; break;
816 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16; break;
817 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL; break;
818 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21; break;
819 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF; break;
820 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16; break;
821 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO; break;
822 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI; break;
823 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA; break;
824 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD; break;
825 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA; break;
826 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8; break;
827 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15; break;
828 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24; break;
829 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A; break;
830 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D; break;
831 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A; break;
832 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D; break;
833 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A; break;
834 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D; break;
835 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21; break;
836 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO; break;
837 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
838 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
839 break;
840 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
841 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
842 break;
843 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
844 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
845 break;
846 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
847 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
848 break;
849 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
850 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
851 break;
852 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
853 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
854 break;
855 case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16; break;
856 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_LO; break;
857 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HI; break;
858 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HA; break;
859 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_16DX_HA; break;
860 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA; break;
861 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT; break;
862 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY; break;
863 }
864
865 return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
866 };
867
868 static reloc_howto_type *
869 ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
870 const char *r_name)
871 {
872 unsigned int i;
873
874 for (i = 0;
875 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
876 i++)
877 if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
878 && strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
879 return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
880
881 return NULL;
882 }
883
884 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
885
886 static bfd_boolean
887 ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
888 arelent *cache_ptr,
889 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
890 {
891 unsigned int r_type;
892
893 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
894 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
895 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
896
897 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
898 if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
899 {
900 /* xgettext:c-format */
901 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
902 abfd, r_type);
903 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
904 return FALSE;
905 }
906
907 cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
908
909 /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
910 ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation. */
911 if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
912 {
913 /* xgettext:c-format */
914 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
915 abfd, r_type);
916 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
917
918 return FALSE;
919 }
920
921 return TRUE;
922 }
923
924 /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs. */
925
926 static bfd_reloc_status_type
927 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
928 arelent *reloc_entry,
929 asymbol *symbol,
930 void *data,
931 asection *input_section,
932 bfd *output_bfd,
933 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
934 {
935 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
936 long insn;
937 bfd_size_type octets;
938 bfd_vma value;
939
940 if (output_bfd != NULL)
941 {
942 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
943 return bfd_reloc_ok;
944 }
945
946 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
947 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
948 if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
949 return bfd_reloc_continue;
950
951 value = 0;
952 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
953 value = symbol->value;
954 value += (reloc_entry->addend
955 + symbol->section->output_offset
956 + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
957 value -= (reloc_entry->address
958 + input_section->output_offset
959 + input_section->output_section->vma);
960 value >>= 16;
961
962 octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
963 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
964 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
965 insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
966 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
967 return bfd_reloc_ok;
968 }
969
970 static bfd_reloc_status_type
971 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
972 arelent *reloc_entry,
973 asymbol *symbol,
974 void *data,
975 asection *input_section,
976 bfd *output_bfd,
977 char **error_message)
978 {
979 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
980 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
981 link time. */
982 if (output_bfd != NULL)
983 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
984 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
985
986 if (error_message != NULL)
987 {
988 static char buf[60];
989 sprintf (buf, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
990 reloc_entry->howto->name);
991 *error_message = buf;
992 }
993 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
994 }
995 \f
996 /* Sections created by the linker. */
997
998 typedef struct elf_linker_section
999 {
1000 /* Pointer to the bfd section. */
1001 asection *section;
1002 /* Section name. */
1003 const char *name;
1004 /* Associated bss section name. */
1005 const char *bss_name;
1006 /* Associated symbol name. */
1007 const char *sym_name;
1008 /* Associated symbol. */
1009 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
1010 } elf_linker_section_t;
1011
1012 /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries. This hangs off of the
1013 symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
1014 based on different addend's. */
1015
1016 typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
1017 {
1018 /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
1019 struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
1020 /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
1021 bfd_vma offset;
1022 /* addend used */
1023 bfd_vma addend;
1024 /* which linker section this is */
1025 elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
1026 } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
1027
1028 struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
1029 {
1030 struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1031
1032 /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
1033 sections added. This is index by the symbol index. */
1034 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
1035
1036 /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type. */
1037 unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
1038 unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
1039 };
1040
1041 #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1042 ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1043
1044 #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
1045 (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
1046
1047 #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
1048 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1049 && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
1050
1051 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1052
1053 static bfd_boolean
1054 ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1055 {
1056 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
1057 PPC32_ELF_DATA);
1058 }
1059
1060 /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match. */
1061
1062 bfd_boolean
1063 _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
1064 {
1065 unsigned long mach = 0;
1066 asection *s;
1067 unsigned char *contents;
1068
1069 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
1070 && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
1071 {
1072
1073 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1074 if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1075 break;
1076 if (s != NULL)
1077 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1078 }
1079
1080 if (mach == 0)
1081 {
1082 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1083 if (s != NULL
1084 && s->size >= 24
1085 && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
1086 {
1087 unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
1088 unsigned int i;
1089
1090 for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
1091 {
1092 unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
1093 switch (val >> 16)
1094 {
1095 case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
1096 case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
1097 if (mach == 0)
1098 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
1099 break;
1100
1101 case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
1102 case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
1103 if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
1104 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
1105 break;
1106
1107 case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
1108 case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
1109 case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
1110 if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
1111 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
1112 break;
1113
1114 case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
1115 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1116 break;
1117
1118 default:
1119 mach = -1ul;
1120 }
1121 }
1122 free (contents);
1123 }
1124 }
1125
1126 if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
1127 {
1128 const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
1129
1130 for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
1131 if (arch->mach == mach)
1132 {
1133 abfd->arch_info = arch;
1134 break;
1135 }
1136 }
1137 return TRUE;
1138 }
1139
1140 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
1141 default is 64 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1142
1143 static bfd_boolean
1144 ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1145 {
1146 if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1147 return TRUE;
1148
1149 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
1150 {
1151 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1152
1153 if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
1154 {
1155 /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default. */
1156 abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1157 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
1158 }
1159 }
1160 return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1161 }
1162
1163 /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set. */
1164
1165 static bfd_boolean
1166 ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
1167 {
1168 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
1169 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
1170
1171 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
1172 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
1173 return TRUE;
1174 }
1175
1176 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1177
1178 static bfd_boolean
1179 ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1180 {
1181 int offset;
1182 unsigned int size;
1183
1184 switch (note->descsz)
1185 {
1186 default:
1187 return FALSE;
1188
1189 case 268: /* Linux/PPC. */
1190 /* pr_cursig */
1191 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1192
1193 /* pr_pid */
1194 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1195
1196 /* pr_reg */
1197 offset = 72;
1198 size = 192;
1199
1200 break;
1201 }
1202
1203 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1204 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1205 size, note->descpos + offset);
1206 }
1207
1208 static bfd_boolean
1209 ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1210 {
1211 switch (note->descsz)
1212 {
1213 default:
1214 return FALSE;
1215
1216 case 128: /* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo. */
1217 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1218 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
1219 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1220 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
1221 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1222 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
1223 }
1224
1225 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
1226 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
1227 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
1228
1229 {
1230 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
1231 int n = strlen (command);
1232
1233 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
1234 command[n - 1] = '\0';
1235 }
1236
1237 return TRUE;
1238 }
1239
1240 static char *
1241 ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
1242 {
1243 switch (note_type)
1244 {
1245 default:
1246 return NULL;
1247
1248 case NT_PRPSINFO:
1249 {
1250 char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1251 va_list ap;
1252
1253 va_start (ap, note_type);
1254 memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1255 strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1256 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1257 DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1258 /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1259 -Wstringop-truncation:
1260 https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1261 */
1262 DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1263 #endif
1264 strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1265 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1266 DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1267 #endif
1268 va_end (ap);
1269 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1270 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1271 }
1272
1273 case NT_PRSTATUS:
1274 {
1275 char data[268];
1276 va_list ap;
1277 long pid;
1278 int cursig;
1279 const void *greg;
1280
1281 va_start (ap, note_type);
1282 memset (data, 0, 72);
1283 pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1284 bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
1285 cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1286 bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1287 greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1288 memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
1289 memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
1290 va_end (ap);
1291 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1292 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1293 }
1294 }
1295 }
1296
1297 static flagword
1298 ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
1299 {
1300
1301 if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
1302 return SHF_PPC_VLE;
1303
1304 return 0;
1305 }
1306
1307 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
1308 or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
1309
1310 static bfd_vma
1311 ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1312 const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1313 const arelent *rel)
1314 {
1315 return rel->address;
1316 }
1317
1318 /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file. This
1319 is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
1320 type. */
1321
1322 static bfd_boolean
1323 ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1324 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1325 const char *name,
1326 int shindex)
1327 {
1328 asection *newsect;
1329 flagword flags;
1330
1331 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1332 return FALSE;
1333
1334 newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
1335 flags = bfd_section_flags (newsect);
1336 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
1337 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1338
1339 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
1340 flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
1341
1342 bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, flags);
1343 return TRUE;
1344 }
1345
1346 /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary. */
1347
1348 static bfd_boolean
1349 ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1350 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
1351 asection *asect)
1352 {
1353 if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
1354 shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
1355
1356 return TRUE;
1357 }
1358
1359 /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
1360 need to bump up the number of section headers. */
1361
1362 static int
1363 ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
1364 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1365 {
1366 asection *s;
1367 int ret = 0;
1368
1369 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
1370 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1371 ++ret;
1372
1373 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
1374 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1375 ++ret;
1376
1377 return ret;
1378 }
1379
1380 /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables. */
1381
1382 bfd_boolean
1383 ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
1384 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1385 {
1386 struct elf_segment_map *m;
1387
1388 /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
1389 LMA and assigned to segments. All that is left to do is to ensure
1390 there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
1391 If we find that case, we split the segment.
1392 We maintain the original output section order. */
1393
1394 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
1395 {
1396 struct elf_segment_map *n;
1397 bfd_size_type amt;
1398 unsigned int j, k;
1399 unsigned int p_flags;
1400
1401 if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
1402 continue;
1403
1404 for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
1405 {
1406 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1407 p_flags |= PF_W;
1408 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1409 {
1410 p_flags |= PF_X;
1411 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1412 p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1413 break;
1414 }
1415 }
1416 if (j != m->count)
1417 while (++j != m->count)
1418 {
1419 unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
1420
1421 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1422 p_flags1 |= PF_W;
1423 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1424 {
1425 p_flags1 |= PF_X;
1426 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1427 p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1428 if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1429 break;
1430 }
1431 p_flags |= p_flags1;
1432 }
1433 /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
1434 sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
1435 two parts. So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
1436 are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set. */
1437 if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
1438 {
1439 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
1440 m->p_flags = p_flags;
1441 }
1442 if (j == m->count)
1443 continue;
1444
1445 /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
1446 the remainder are put in a new segment.
1447 The scan resumes with the new segment. */
1448
1449 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
1450 amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
1451 n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1452 if (n == NULL)
1453 return FALSE;
1454
1455 n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
1456 n->count = m->count - j;
1457 for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
1458 n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
1459 m->count = j;
1460 m->p_size_valid = 0;
1461 n->next = m->next;
1462 m->next = n;
1463 }
1464
1465 return TRUE;
1466 }
1467
1468 /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
1469 .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
1470 that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
1471 2 sections. */
1472
1473 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
1474 {
1475 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
1476 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1477 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1478 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1479 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1480 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
1481 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
1482 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1483 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1484 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1485 };
1486
1487 /* This is what we want for new plt/got. */
1488 static struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
1489 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
1490
1491 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
1492 ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1493 {
1494 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
1495
1496 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
1497 if (sec->name == NULL)
1498 return NULL;
1499
1500 ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
1501 sec->use_rela_p);
1502 if (ssect != NULL)
1503 {
1504 if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1505 ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
1506 return ssect;
1507 }
1508
1509 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
1510 }
1511 \f
1512 /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values. */
1513 typedef struct apuinfo_list
1514 {
1515 struct apuinfo_list *next;
1516 unsigned long value;
1517 }
1518 apuinfo_list;
1519
1520 static apuinfo_list *head;
1521 static bfd_boolean apuinfo_set;
1522
1523 static void
1524 apuinfo_list_init (void)
1525 {
1526 head = NULL;
1527 apuinfo_set = FALSE;
1528 }
1529
1530 static void
1531 apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
1532 {
1533 apuinfo_list *entry = head;
1534
1535 while (entry != NULL)
1536 {
1537 if (entry->value == value)
1538 return;
1539 entry = entry->next;
1540 }
1541
1542 entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
1543 if (entry == NULL)
1544 return;
1545
1546 entry->value = value;
1547 entry->next = head;
1548 head = entry;
1549 }
1550
1551 static unsigned
1552 apuinfo_list_length (void)
1553 {
1554 apuinfo_list *entry;
1555 unsigned long count;
1556
1557 for (entry = head, count = 0;
1558 entry;
1559 entry = entry->next)
1560 ++ count;
1561
1562 return count;
1563 }
1564
1565 static inline unsigned long
1566 apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
1567 {
1568 apuinfo_list * entry;
1569
1570 for (entry = head;
1571 entry && number --;
1572 entry = entry->next)
1573 ;
1574
1575 return entry ? entry->value : 0;
1576 }
1577
1578 static void
1579 apuinfo_list_finish (void)
1580 {
1581 apuinfo_list *entry;
1582
1583 for (entry = head; entry;)
1584 {
1585 apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
1586 free (entry);
1587 entry = next;
1588 }
1589
1590 head = NULL;
1591 }
1592
1593 /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
1594 the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted. */
1595
1596 static void
1597 ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1598 {
1599 bfd *ibfd;
1600 asection *asec;
1601 char *buffer = NULL;
1602 bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
1603 unsigned i;
1604 unsigned long length;
1605 const char *error_message = NULL;
1606
1607 if (link_info == NULL)
1608 return;
1609
1610 apuinfo_list_init ();
1611
1612 /* Read in the input sections contents. */
1613 for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
1614 {
1615 unsigned long datum;
1616
1617 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1618 if (asec == NULL)
1619 continue;
1620
1621 /* xgettext:c-format */
1622 error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
1623 length = asec->size;
1624 if (length < 20)
1625 goto fail;
1626
1627 apuinfo_set = TRUE;
1628 if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
1629 {
1630 if (buffer)
1631 free (buffer);
1632 largest_input_size = asec->size;
1633 buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
1634 if (!buffer)
1635 return;
1636 }
1637
1638 if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
1639 || (bfd_bread (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
1640 {
1641 /* xgettext:c-format */
1642 error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
1643 goto fail;
1644 }
1645
1646 /* Verify the contents of the header. Note - we have to
1647 extract the values this way in order to allow for a
1648 host whose endian-ness is different from the target. */
1649 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
1650 if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
1651 goto fail;
1652
1653 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
1654 if (datum != 0x2)
1655 goto fail;
1656
1657 if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
1658 goto fail;
1659
1660 /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries. */
1661 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
1662 if (datum + 20 != length)
1663 goto fail;
1664
1665 /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers. */
1666 for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
1667 apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
1668 }
1669
1670 error_message = NULL;
1671
1672 if (apuinfo_set)
1673 {
1674 /* Compute the size of the output section. */
1675 unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1676
1677 /* Set the output section size, if it exists. */
1678 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1679
1680 if (asec && !bfd_set_section_size (asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
1681 {
1682 ibfd = abfd;
1683 /* xgettext:c-format */
1684 error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
1685 }
1686 }
1687
1688 fail:
1689 if (buffer)
1690 free (buffer);
1691
1692 if (error_message)
1693 _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
1694 }
1695
1696 /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
1697 contents. We have already stored this in our linked list structure. */
1698
1699 static bfd_boolean
1700 ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1701 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1702 asection *asec,
1703 bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1704 {
1705 return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
1706 }
1707
1708 /* Finally we can generate the output section. */
1709
1710 static void
1711 ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1712 {
1713 bfd_byte *buffer;
1714 asection *asec;
1715 unsigned i;
1716 unsigned num_entries;
1717 bfd_size_type length;
1718
1719 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1720 if (asec == NULL)
1721 return;
1722
1723 if (!apuinfo_set)
1724 return;
1725
1726 length = asec->size;
1727 if (length < 20)
1728 return;
1729
1730 buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
1731 if (buffer == NULL)
1732 {
1733 _bfd_error_handler
1734 (_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
1735 return;
1736 }
1737
1738 /* Create the apuinfo header. */
1739 num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1740 bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
1741 bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
1742 bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
1743 strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
1744
1745 length = 20;
1746 for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
1747 {
1748 bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
1749 length += 4;
1750 }
1751
1752 if (length != asec->size)
1753 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
1754
1755 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
1756 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
1757
1758 free (buffer);
1759
1760 apuinfo_list_finish ();
1761 }
1762
1763 static bfd_boolean
1764 ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1765 {
1766 ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
1767 return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
1768 }
1769 \f
1770 static bfd_boolean
1771 is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
1772 {
1773 bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
1774
1775 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
1776 return FALSE;
1777
1778 return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
1779 && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
1780 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
1781 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
1782 }
1783
1784 static bfd_boolean
1785 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1786 {
1787 bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1788 return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1789 && section->vma <= vma
1790 && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1791 }
1792
1793 static long
1794 ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
1795 long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
1796 asymbol **ret)
1797 {
1798 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
1799 asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
1800 bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
1801 bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
1802 bfd_vma stub_off;
1803 asymbol *s;
1804 arelent *p;
1805 long count, i, stub_delta;
1806 size_t size;
1807 char *names;
1808 bfd_byte buf[4];
1809
1810 *ret = NULL;
1811
1812 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
1813 return 0;
1814
1815 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
1816 return 0;
1817
1818 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
1819 if (relplt == NULL)
1820 return 0;
1821
1822 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
1823 if (plt == NULL)
1824 return 0;
1825
1826 /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs. */
1827 if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
1828 return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
1829 dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
1830
1831 /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
1832 of .glink at got[1]. If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero. */
1833 dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1834 if (dynamic != NULL)
1835 {
1836 bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
1837 size_t extdynsize;
1838 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1839
1840 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
1841 return -1;
1842
1843 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1844 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1845
1846 extdyn = dynbuf;
1847 extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
1848 for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1849 {
1850 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1851 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1852
1853 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1854 break;
1855
1856 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
1857 {
1858 unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1859 asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1860 if (got != NULL
1861 && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
1862 g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
1863 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1864 break;
1865 }
1866 }
1867 free (dynbuf);
1868 }
1869
1870 /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry. */
1871 if (glink_vma == 0)
1872 {
1873 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
1874 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1875 }
1876
1877 if (glink_vma == 0)
1878 return 0;
1879
1880 /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
1881 link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
1882 glink stubs now reside. */
1883 glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
1884 if (glink == NULL)
1885 return 0;
1886
1887 /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
1888 from the first glink stub. */
1889 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1890 glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
1891 {
1892 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1893
1894 /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ... */
1895 insn ^= B;
1896 if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
1897 resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
1898
1899 /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs. */
1900 else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
1901 for (i = 4;
1902 bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1903 glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
1904 i += 4)
1905 if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
1906 {
1907 resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
1908 break;
1909 }
1910 }
1911
1912 count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1913 /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
1914 multiple stubs for each plt entry. If that is the case then
1915 there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
1916 of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
1917 The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
1918 GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt. */
1919 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1920 for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
1921 if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
1922 break;
1923 if (stub_delta > 32)
1924 return 0;
1925
1926 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
1927 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
1928 return -1;
1929
1930 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
1931 p = relplt->relocation;
1932 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
1933 {
1934 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
1935 if (p->addend != 0)
1936 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
1937 }
1938
1939 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
1940
1941 if (resolv_vma)
1942 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1943
1944 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
1945 if (s == NULL)
1946 return -1;
1947
1948 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1949 names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
1950 p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
1951 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1952 {
1953 size_t len;
1954
1955 stub_off -= stub_delta;
1956 if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
1957 stub_off -= 32;
1958 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
1959 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
1960 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
1961 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
1962 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
1963 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1964 s->section = glink;
1965 s->value = stub_off;
1966 s->name = names;
1967 s->udata.p = NULL;
1968 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
1969 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
1970 names += len;
1971 if (p->addend != 0)
1972 {
1973 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
1974 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
1975 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
1976 names += strlen (names);
1977 }
1978 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
1979 names += sizeof ("@plt");
1980 ++s;
1981 --p;
1982 }
1983
1984 /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table. */
1985 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1986 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1987 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1988 s->section = glink;
1989 s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1990 s->name = names;
1991 memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
1992 names += sizeof ("__glink");
1993 s++;
1994 count++;
1995
1996 if (resolv_vma)
1997 {
1998 /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver. */
1999 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
2000 s->the_bfd = abfd;
2001 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2002 s->section = glink;
2003 s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2004 s->name = names;
2005 memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2006 names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2007 s++;
2008 count++;
2009 }
2010
2011 return count;
2012 }
2013 \f
2014 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2015 functions above are used generally. They appear in this file more
2016 or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2017 ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2018 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2019 called. */
2020
2021 /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
2022 than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary. */
2023 struct plt_entry
2024 {
2025 struct plt_entry *next;
2026
2027 /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
2028 This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
2029 GOT pointer reg. It will always be at least 32768. (Current
2030 gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
2031 sections together resulting in larger offsets). */
2032 bfd_vma addend;
2033
2034 /* The .got2 section. */
2035 asection *sec;
2036
2037 /* PLT refcount or offset. */
2038 union
2039 {
2040 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2041 bfd_vma offset;
2042 } plt;
2043
2044 /* .glink stub offset. */
2045 bfd_vma glink_offset;
2046 };
2047
2048 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2049 function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2050 library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2051
2052 static int
2053 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2054 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2055 {
2056 switch (r_type)
2057 {
2058 default:
2059 /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2060 address isn't fixed. DTPREL32 is excluded because the
2061 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2062 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set. */
2063 return 1;
2064
2065 case R_PPC_REL24:
2066 case R_PPC_REL14:
2067 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
2068 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
2069 case R_PPC_REL32:
2070 return 0;
2071
2072 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
2073 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
2074 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
2075 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
2076 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
2077 /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2078 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2079 return bfd_link_dll (info);
2080 }
2081 }
2082
2083 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2084 copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2085 section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2086 shared lib. */
2087 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2088
2089 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
2090 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2091 {
2092 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2093
2094 /* The input section of the reloc. */
2095 asection *sec;
2096
2097 /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
2098 unsigned int count : 31;
2099
2100 /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
2101 unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2102 };
2103
2104 /* PPC ELF linker hash entry. */
2105
2106 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
2107 {
2108 struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2109
2110 /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
2111 specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
2112 from the beginning of the section. */
2113 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
2114
2115 /* Track dynamic relocs copied for this symbol. */
2116 struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
2117
2118 /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
2119 Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2120 encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2121 of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
2122 optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2123 needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
2124 set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
2125 These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
2126 #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
2127 #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
2128 #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
2129 #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2130 #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2131 #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2132 #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2133 unsigned char tls_mask;
2134
2135 /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
2136 case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
2137 #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
2138 #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
2139 #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
2140
2141 /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
2142 symbol. */
2143 unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
2144
2145 /* Flag use of given relocations. */
2146 unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
2147 unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
2148 };
2149
2150 #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
2151
2152 /* PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2153
2154 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
2155 {
2156 struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2157
2158 /* Various options passed from the linker. */
2159 struct ppc_elf_params *params;
2160
2161 /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
2162 asection *glink;
2163 asection *dynsbss;
2164 asection *relsbss;
2165 elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
2166 asection *sbss;
2167 asection *glink_eh_frame;
2168 asection *pltlocal;
2169 asection *relpltlocal;
2170
2171 /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks. */
2172 asection *srelplt2;
2173
2174 /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr. */
2175 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2176
2177 /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT. */
2178 bfd *old_bfd;
2179
2180 /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. */
2181 union {
2182 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2183 bfd_vma offset;
2184 } tlsld_got;
2185
2186 /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink. */
2187 bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
2188
2189 /* Size of reserved GOT entries. */
2190 unsigned int got_header_size;
2191 /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap. */
2192 unsigned int got_gap;
2193
2194 /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use. */
2195 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
2196
2197 /* True if the target system is VxWorks. */
2198 unsigned int is_vxworks:1;
2199
2200 /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2201 referenced by dynamic relocations. */
2202 unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2203 unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2204
2205 /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
2206 unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2207
2208 /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
2209 unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2210
2211 /* The size of PLT entries. */
2212 int plt_entry_size;
2213 /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots. */
2214 int plt_slot_size;
2215 /* The size of the first PLT entry. */
2216 int plt_initial_entry_size;
2217
2218 /* Small local sym cache. */
2219 struct sym_cache sym_cache;
2220 };
2221
2222 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2223 are used for ppc32. The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects. */
2224
2225 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
2226 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2227
2228 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker
2229 relocs. */
2230 #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1
2231
2232 /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
2233 #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
2234
2235 /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
2236
2237 #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
2238 (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
2239 == PPC32_ELF_DATA ? ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
2240
2241 /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2242
2243 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
2244 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
2245 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
2246 const char *string)
2247 {
2248 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
2249 subclass. */
2250 if (entry == NULL)
2251 {
2252 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
2253 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
2254 if (entry == NULL)
2255 return entry;
2256 }
2257
2258 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
2259 entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
2260 if (entry != NULL)
2261 {
2262 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
2263 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2264 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
2265 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
2266 }
2267
2268 return entry;
2269 }
2270
2271 /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2272
2273 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
2274 ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
2275 {
2276 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
2277 static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
2278 = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
2279
2280 ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
2281 if (ret == NULL)
2282 return NULL;
2283
2284 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
2285 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
2286 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
2287 PPC32_ELF_DATA))
2288 {
2289 free (ret);
2290 return NULL;
2291 }
2292
2293 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
2294 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
2295 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
2296 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
2297
2298 ret->params = &default_params;
2299
2300 ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
2301 ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
2302 ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
2303
2304 ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
2305 ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
2306 ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
2307
2308 ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
2309 ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
2310 ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
2311
2312 return &ret->elf.root;
2313 }
2314
2315 /* Hook linker params into hash table. */
2316
2317 void
2318 ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
2319 {
2320 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2321
2322 if (htab)
2323 htab->params = params;
2324 params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
2325 }
2326
2327 /* Create .got and the related sections. */
2328
2329 static bfd_boolean
2330 ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2331 {
2332 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2333
2334 if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
2335 return FALSE;
2336
2337 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2338 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
2339 {
2340 /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it. Mark it
2341 executable. */
2342 flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2343 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2344 if (!bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
2345 return FALSE;
2346 }
2347
2348 return TRUE;
2349 }
2350
2351 /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
2352 R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers. These sections become part of .sdata
2353 and .sdata2. Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too. */
2354
2355 static bfd_boolean
2356 ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2357 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2358 flagword flags,
2359 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2360 {
2361 asection *s;
2362
2363 flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2364 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2365
2366 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
2367 if (s == NULL)
2368 return FALSE;
2369 lsect->section = s;
2370
2371 /* Define the sym on the first section of this name. */
2372 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
2373
2374 lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
2375 if (lsect->sym == NULL)
2376 return FALSE;
2377 lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
2378 return TRUE;
2379 }
2380
2381 static bfd_boolean
2382 ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2383 {
2384 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2385 asection *s;
2386 flagword flags;
2387 int p2align;
2388
2389 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2390 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2391 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
2392 htab->glink = s;
2393 p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
2394 if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
2395 p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
2396 if (s == NULL
2397 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, p2align))
2398 return FALSE;
2399
2400 if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
2401 {
2402 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2403 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2404 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
2405 htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
2406 if (s == NULL
2407 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2408 return FALSE;
2409 }
2410
2411 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2412 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
2413 htab->elf.iplt = s;
2414 if (s == NULL
2415 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 4))
2416 return FALSE;
2417
2418 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2419 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2420 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
2421 htab->elf.irelplt = s;
2422 if (s == NULL
2423 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2424 return FALSE;
2425
2426 /* Local plt entries. */
2427 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
2428 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2429 htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
2430 flags);
2431 if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
2432 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 2))
2433 return FALSE;
2434
2435 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2436 {
2437 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
2438 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2439 htab->relpltlocal
2440 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
2441 if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
2442 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 2))
2443 return FALSE;
2444 }
2445
2446 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
2447 &htab->sdata[0]))
2448 return FALSE;
2449
2450 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
2451 &htab->sdata[1]))
2452 return FALSE;
2453
2454 return TRUE;
2455 }
2456
2457 /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
2458 to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
2459 to create .dynbss and .rela.bss). */
2460
2461 static bfd_boolean
2462 ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2463 {
2464 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2465 asection *s;
2466 flagword flags;
2467
2468 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2469
2470 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2471 && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
2472 return FALSE;
2473
2474 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
2475 return FALSE;
2476
2477 if (htab->glink == NULL
2478 && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
2479 return FALSE;
2480
2481 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
2482 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2483 htab->dynsbss = s;
2484 if (s == NULL)
2485 return FALSE;
2486
2487 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2488 {
2489 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2490 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2491 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
2492 htab->relsbss = s;
2493 if (s == NULL
2494 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2495 return FALSE;
2496 }
2497
2498 if (htab->is_vxworks
2499 && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
2500 return FALSE;
2501
2502 s = htab->elf.splt;
2503 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2504 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
2505 /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents. */
2506 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
2507 return bfd_set_section_flags (s, flags);
2508 }
2509
2510 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
2511
2512 static void
2513 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2514 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
2515 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
2516 {
2517 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
2518
2519 edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
2520 eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
2521
2522 edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
2523 edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
2524
2525 if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
2526 edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
2527 edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
2528 edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
2529 edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
2530 edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
2531 edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
2532
2533 /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all. */
2534 if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2535 return;
2536
2537 if (eind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2538 {
2539 if (edir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2540 {
2541 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2542 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2543
2544 /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
2545 list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
2546 for (pp = &eind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2547 {
2548 struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
2549
2550 for (q = edir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
2551 if (q->sec == p->sec)
2552 {
2553 q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
2554 q->count += p->count;
2555 *pp = p->next;
2556 break;
2557 }
2558 if (q == NULL)
2559 pp = &p->next;
2560 }
2561 *pp = edir->dyn_relocs;
2562 }
2563
2564 edir->dyn_relocs = eind->dyn_relocs;
2565 eind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2566 }
2567
2568 /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
2569 the symbol which just became indirect. */
2570 edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
2571 eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
2572
2573 /* And plt entries. */
2574 if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2575 {
2576 if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2577 {
2578 struct plt_entry **entp;
2579 struct plt_entry *ent;
2580
2581 for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
2582 {
2583 struct plt_entry *dent;
2584
2585 for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
2586 if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
2587 {
2588 dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
2589 *entp = ent->next;
2590 break;
2591 }
2592 if (dent == NULL)
2593 entp = &ent->next;
2594 }
2595 *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
2596 }
2597
2598 edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
2599 eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
2600 }
2601
2602 if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
2603 {
2604 if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
2605 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2606 edir->elf.dynstr_index);
2607 edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
2608 edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
2609 eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
2610 eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
2611 }
2612 }
2613
2614 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
2615 file. We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss. */
2616
2617 static bfd_boolean
2618 ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
2619 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2620 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
2621 const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2622 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2623 asection **secp,
2624 bfd_vma *valp)
2625 {
2626 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
2627 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
2628 && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
2629 && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
2630 {
2631 /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
2632 put into .sbss. */
2633 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2634
2635 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2636 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2637 {
2638 flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2639
2640 if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
2641 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2642
2643 htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2644 ".sbss",
2645 flags);
2646 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2647 return FALSE;
2648 }
2649
2650 *secp = htab->sbss;
2651 *valp = sym->st_size;
2652 }
2653
2654 return TRUE;
2655 }
2656 \f
2657 /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type. */
2658
2659 static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
2660 elf_find_pointer_linker_section
2661 (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
2662 bfd_vma addend,
2663 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2664 {
2665 for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
2666 if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
2667 return linker_pointers;
2668
2669 return NULL;
2670 }
2671
2672 /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section. */
2673
2674 static bfd_boolean
2675 elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2676 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
2677 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2678 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
2679 {
2680 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
2681 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
2682 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2683 bfd_size_type amt;
2684
2685 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
2686
2687 /* Is this a global symbol? */
2688 if (h != NULL)
2689 {
2690 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
2691
2692 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2693 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2694 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
2695 rel->r_addend,
2696 lsect))
2697 return TRUE;
2698
2699 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
2700 }
2701 else
2702 {
2703 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2704
2705 /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol. */
2706 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
2707
2708 /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time. */
2709 if (!ptr)
2710 {
2711 unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
2712
2713 amt = num_symbols;
2714 amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
2715 ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2716
2717 if (!ptr)
2718 return FALSE;
2719
2720 elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
2721 }
2722
2723 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2724 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
2725 rel->r_addend,
2726 lsect))
2727 return TRUE;
2728
2729 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
2730 }
2731
2732 /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
2733 a new pointer record from internal memory. */
2734 BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
2735 amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
2736 linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2737
2738 if (!linker_section_ptr)
2739 return FALSE;
2740
2741 linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
2742 linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
2743 linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
2744 *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
2745
2746 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section, 2))
2747 return FALSE;
2748 linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
2749 lsect->section->size += 4;
2750
2751 #ifdef DEBUG
2752 fprintf (stderr,
2753 "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
2754 lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
2755 (long) lsect->section->size);
2756 #endif
2757
2758 return TRUE;
2759 }
2760
2761 static struct plt_entry **
2762 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
2763 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
2764 unsigned long r_symndx,
2765 int tls_type)
2766 {
2767 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2768 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
2769 unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
2770
2771 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2772 {
2773 bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2774
2775 size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
2776 + sizeof (*local_plt)
2777 + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
2778 local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
2779 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2780 return NULL;
2781 elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2782 }
2783
2784 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2785 local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2786 local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
2787 if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
2788 local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2789 return local_plt + r_symndx;
2790 }
2791
2792 static bfd_boolean
2793 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
2794 asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2795 {
2796 struct plt_entry *ent;
2797
2798 if (addend < 32768)
2799 sec = NULL;
2800 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2801 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2802 break;
2803 if (ent == NULL)
2804 {
2805 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
2806 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2807 if (ent == NULL)
2808 return FALSE;
2809 ent->next = *plist;
2810 ent->sec = sec;
2811 ent->addend = addend;
2812 ent->plt.refcount = 0;
2813 *plist = ent;
2814 }
2815 ent->plt.refcount += 1;
2816 return TRUE;
2817 }
2818
2819 static struct plt_entry *
2820 find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2821 {
2822 struct plt_entry *ent;
2823
2824 if (addend < 32768)
2825 sec = NULL;
2826 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2827 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2828 break;
2829 return ent;
2830 }
2831
2832 static bfd_boolean
2833 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2834 {
2835 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2836 || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
2837 || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
2838 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
2839 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
2840 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
2841 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
2842 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
2843 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
2844 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
2845 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
2846 }
2847
2848 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
2849
2850 static bfd_boolean
2851 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2852 {
2853 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
2854 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2855 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2856 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
2857 }
2858
2859 static void
2860 bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2861 {
2862 _bfd_error_handler
2863 /* xgettext:c-format */
2864 (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
2865 abfd,
2866 ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
2867 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2868 }
2869
2870 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2871 allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
2872 table. */
2873
2874 static bfd_boolean
2875 ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
2876 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2877 asection *sec,
2878 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2879 {
2880 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2881 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2882 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2883 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2884 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2885 asection *got2, *sreloc;
2886 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
2887
2888 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2889 return TRUE;
2890
2891 /* Don't do anything special with non-loaded, non-alloced sections.
2892 In particular, any relocs in such sections should not affect GOT
2893 and PLT reference counting (ie. we don't allow them to create GOT
2894 or PLT entries), there's no possibility or desire to optimize TLS
2895 relocs, and there's not much point in propagating relocs to shared
2896 libs that the dynamic linker won't relocate. */
2897 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
2898 return TRUE;
2899
2900 #ifdef DEBUG
2901 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
2902 sec, abfd);
2903 #endif
2904
2905 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2906
2907 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
2908 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
2909 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
2910
2911 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2912 if (htab->glink == NULL)
2913 {
2914 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2915 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2916 if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2917 return FALSE;
2918 }
2919 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
2920 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
2921 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2922 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2923 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
2924 sreloc = NULL;
2925
2926 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2927 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2928 {
2929 unsigned long r_symndx;
2930 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
2931 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2932 int tls_type;
2933 struct plt_entry **ifunc;
2934 struct plt_entry **pltent;
2935 bfd_vma addend;
2936
2937 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2938 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2939 h = NULL;
2940 else
2941 {
2942 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2943 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2944 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2945 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2946 }
2947
2948 /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
2949 This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
2950 startup code. */
2951 if (h != NULL
2952 && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2953 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
2954 {
2955 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2956 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2957 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2958 return FALSE;
2959 BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
2960 }
2961
2962 tls_type = 0;
2963 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2964 ifunc = NULL;
2965 if (h == NULL && !htab->is_vxworks)
2966 {
2967 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
2968 abfd, r_symndx);
2969 if (isym == NULL)
2970 return FALSE;
2971
2972 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2973 {
2974 /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet. */
2975 ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
2976 NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
2977 if (ifunc == NULL)
2978 return FALSE;
2979
2980 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
2981 In a non-pie executable even when there are
2982 no plt calls. */
2983 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
2984 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2985 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2986 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2987 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
2988 {
2989 addend = 0;
2990 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
2991 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
2992 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
2993 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2994 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2995 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2996 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
2997 addend = rel->r_addend;
2998 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
2999 return FALSE;
3000 }
3001 }
3002 }
3003
3004 if (!htab->is_vxworks
3005 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
3006 && h != NULL
3007 && h == tga)
3008 {
3009 if (rel != relocs
3010 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
3011 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
3012 /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
3013 reloc. */
3014 ;
3015 else
3016 /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
3017 sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1;
3018 }
3019
3020 switch (r_type)
3021 {
3022 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
3023 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
3024 /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
3025 its parameter symbol. */
3026 if (h != NULL)
3027 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
3028 else
3029 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3030 NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
3031 return FALSE;
3032 break;
3033
3034 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
3035 break;
3036
3037 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
3038 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
3039 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
3040 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
3041 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
3042 goto dogottls;
3043
3044 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
3045 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
3046 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
3047 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
3048 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
3049 goto dogottls;
3050
3051 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
3052 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
3053 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
3054 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
3055 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3056 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3057 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
3058 goto dogottls;
3059
3060 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
3061 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
3062 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
3063 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
3064 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
3065 dogottls:
3066 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3067 /* Fall through. */
3068
3069 /* GOT16 relocations */
3070 case R_PPC_GOT16:
3071 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
3072 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
3073 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
3074 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
3075 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
3076 {
3077 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3078 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3079 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3080 return FALSE;
3081 }
3082 if (h != NULL)
3083 {
3084 h->got.refcount += 1;
3085 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
3086 }
3087 else
3088 /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
3089 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
3090 return FALSE;
3091
3092 /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3093 an ifunc. */
3094 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3095 {
3096 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3097 return FALSE;
3098 }
3099 break;
3100
3101 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
3102 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
3103 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3104 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
3105 h, rel))
3106 return FALSE;
3107 if (h != NULL)
3108 {
3109 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3110 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3111 }
3112 break;
3113
3114 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
3115 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
3116 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3117 {
3118 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3119 return FALSE;
3120 }
3121 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3122 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
3123 h, rel))
3124 return FALSE;
3125 if (h != NULL)
3126 {
3127 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3128 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3129 }
3130 break;
3131
3132 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
3133 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3134 /* Fall through. */
3135
3136 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
3137 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
3138 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
3139 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
3140 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
3141 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
3142 if (h != NULL)
3143 {
3144 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3145 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3146 }
3147 break;
3148
3149 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
3150 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
3151 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
3152 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
3153 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
3154 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
3155 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
3156 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
3157 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
3158 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
3159 break;
3160
3161 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
3162 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3163 {
3164 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3165 return FALSE;
3166 }
3167 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3168 if (h != NULL)
3169 {
3170 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3171 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3172 }
3173 break;
3174
3175 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
3176 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
3177 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
3178 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
3179 if (h != NULL)
3180 {
3181 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3182 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3183 }
3184 break;
3185
3186 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
3187 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
3188 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
3189 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
3190 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
3191 if (h != NULL)
3192 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3193 break;
3194
3195 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
3196 if (h == NULL)
3197 break;
3198 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3199 goto pltentry;
3200
3201 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
3202 sec->has_pltcall = 1;
3203 /* Fall through. */
3204
3205 case R_PPC_PLT32:
3206 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
3207 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
3208 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
3209 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
3210 pltentry:
3211 #ifdef DEBUG
3212 fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
3213 #endif
3214 /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
3215 if (h == NULL)
3216 {
3217 pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3218 NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
3219 if (pltent == NULL)
3220 return FALSE;
3221 }
3222 else
3223 {
3224 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3225 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
3226 h->needs_plt = 1;
3227 pltent = &h->plt.plist;
3228 }
3229 addend = 0;
3230 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3231 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3232 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3233 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3234 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3235 addend = rel->r_addend;
3236 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
3237 return FALSE;
3238 break;
3239
3240 /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
3241 relocation if linking a shared object since they are
3242 section relative. */
3243 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
3244 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
3245 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
3246 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
3247 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
3248 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
3249 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
3250 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
3251 case R_PPC_TOC16:
3252 break;
3253
3254 case R_PPC_REL16:
3255 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
3256 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
3257 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
3258 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
3259 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
3260 break;
3261
3262 /* These are just markers. */
3263 case R_PPC_TLS:
3264 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
3265 case R_PPC_NONE:
3266 case R_PPC_max:
3267 case R_PPC_RELAX:
3268 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
3269 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
3270 case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
3271 break;
3272
3273 /* These should only appear in dynamic objects. */
3274 case R_PPC_COPY:
3275 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
3276 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
3277 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
3278 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
3279 break;
3280
3281 /* These aren't handled yet. We'll report an error later. */
3282 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
3283 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
3284 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
3285 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
3286 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
3287 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
3288 break;
3289
3290 /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library. */
3291 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
3292 if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3293 {
3294 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3295 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3296 }
3297 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
3298 {
3299 h->needs_plt = 1;
3300 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3301 return FALSE;
3302 }
3303 break;
3304
3305 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
3306 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
3307 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3308 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
3309 return FALSE;
3310 break;
3311
3312 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
3313 used. Record for later use during GC. */
3314 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
3315 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
3316 return FALSE;
3317 break;
3318
3319 /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32. */
3320 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
3321 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
3322 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
3323 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
3324 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
3325 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3326 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3327 goto dodyn;
3328
3329 /* Nor these. */
3330 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
3331 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
3332 goto dodyn;
3333
3334 case R_PPC_REL32:
3335 if (h == NULL
3336 && got2 != NULL
3337 && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
3338 && bfd_link_pic (info)
3339 && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3340 {
3341 /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
3342 the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
3343 reference to .got2. If we detect one of these, then
3344 force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
3345 reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
3346 PLT call stubs. */
3347 asection *s;
3348 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3349
3350 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3351 abfd, r_symndx);
3352 if (isym == NULL)
3353 return FALSE;
3354
3355 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3356 if (s == got2)
3357 {
3358 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3359 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3360 }
3361 }
3362 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
3363 break;
3364 /* fall through */
3365
3366 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
3367 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
3368 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
3369 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
3370 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
3371 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
3372 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
3373 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3374 {
3375 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3376 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3377 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3378 return FALSE;
3379
3380 /* We may need a copy reloc too. */
3381 h->non_got_ref = 1;
3382 h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
3383 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
3384 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
3385 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
3386 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
3387 }
3388 goto dodyn;
3389
3390 case R_PPC_REL24:
3391 case R_PPC_REL14:
3392 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
3393 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
3394 if (h == NULL)
3395 break;
3396 if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
3397 {
3398 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3399 {
3400 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3401 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3402 }
3403 break;
3404 }
3405 /* fall through */
3406
3407 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
3408 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
3409 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
3410 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
3411 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3412 {
3413 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3414 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3415 h->needs_plt = 1;
3416 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3417 return FALSE;
3418 break;
3419 }
3420
3421 dodyn:
3422 /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
3423 against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
3424 against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
3425 into the shared library. However, if we are linking with
3426 -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
3427 global symbol which is defined in an object we are
3428 including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set). At
3429 this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
3430 possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
3431 later (it is never cleared). In case of a weak definition,
3432 DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
3433 a shared library. We account for that possibility below by
3434 storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
3435 table entry. A similar situation occurs when creating
3436 shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
3437 symbol local.
3438
3439 If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
3440 may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
3441 dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
3442 symbol. */
3443 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
3444 && (must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)
3445 || (h != NULL
3446 && (!SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h)
3447 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3448 || !h->def_regular))))
3449 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
3450 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
3451 && h != NULL
3452 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3453 || !h->def_regular)))
3454 {
3455 #ifdef DEBUG
3456 fprintf (stderr,
3457 "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
3458 "create relocation for %s\n",
3459 (h && h->root.root.string
3460 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
3461 #endif
3462 if (sreloc == NULL)
3463 {
3464 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3465 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3466
3467 sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
3468 (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
3469
3470 if (sreloc == NULL)
3471 return FALSE;
3472 }
3473
3474 /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
3475 relocations we need for this symbol. */
3476 if (h != NULL)
3477 {
3478 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3479 struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3480
3481 rel_head = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs;
3482 p = *rel_head;
3483 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
3484 {
3485 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3486 if (p == NULL)
3487 return FALSE;
3488 p->next = *rel_head;
3489 *rel_head = p;
3490 p->sec = sec;
3491 p->count = 0;
3492 p->pc_count = 0;
3493 }
3494 p->count += 1;
3495 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
3496 p->pc_count += 1;
3497 }
3498 else
3499 {
3500 /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
3501 We really need local syms available to do this
3502 easily. Oh well. */
3503 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
3504 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3505 bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
3506 asection *s;
3507 void *vpp;
3508 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3509
3510 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3511 abfd, r_symndx);
3512 if (isym == NULL)
3513 return FALSE;
3514
3515 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3516 if (s == NULL)
3517 s = sec;
3518
3519 vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
3520 rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
3521 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
3522 p = *rel_head;
3523 if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3524 p = p->next;
3525 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3526 {
3527 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3528 if (p == NULL)
3529 return FALSE;
3530 p->next = *rel_head;
3531 *rel_head = p;
3532 p->sec = sec;
3533 p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
3534 p->count = 0;
3535 }
3536 p->count += 1;
3537 }
3538 }
3539
3540 break;
3541 }
3542 }
3543
3544 return TRUE;
3545 }
3546 \f
3547 /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
3548 and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3549 bfd_boolean
3550 _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3551 {
3552 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3553 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3554 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3555 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
3556
3557 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3558 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3559
3560 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3561 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3562
3563 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3564 {
3565 int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
3566 int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
3567 static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
3568
3569 if (in_fp == 0)
3570 ;
3571 else if (out_fp == 0)
3572 {
3573 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3574 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3575 last_fp = ibfd;
3576 }
3577 else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
3578 {
3579 _bfd_error_handler
3580 /* xgettext:c-format */
3581 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3582 last_fp, ibfd);
3583 ret = FALSE;
3584 }
3585 else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
3586 {
3587 _bfd_error_handler
3588 /* xgettext:c-format */
3589 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3590 ibfd, last_fp);
3591 ret = FALSE;
3592 }
3593 else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
3594 {
3595 _bfd_error_handler
3596 /* xgettext:c-format */
3597 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3598 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
3599 ret = FALSE;
3600 }
3601 else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
3602 {
3603 _bfd_error_handler
3604 /* xgettext:c-format */
3605 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3606 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
3607 ret = FALSE;
3608 }
3609
3610 in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
3611 out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
3612 if (in_fp == 0)
3613 ;
3614 else if (out_fp == 0)
3615 {
3616 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3617 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3618 last_ld = ibfd;
3619 }
3620 else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
3621 {
3622 _bfd_error_handler
3623 /* xgettext:c-format */
3624 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3625 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3626 ret = FALSE;
3627 }
3628 else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
3629 {
3630 _bfd_error_handler
3631 /* xgettext:c-format */
3632 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3633 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3634 ret = FALSE;
3635 }
3636 else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
3637 {
3638 _bfd_error_handler
3639 /* xgettext:c-format */
3640 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3641 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3642 ret = FALSE;
3643 }
3644 else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
3645 {
3646 _bfd_error_handler
3647 /* xgettext:c-format */
3648 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3649 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3650 ret = FALSE;
3651 }
3652 }
3653
3654 if (!ret)
3655 {
3656 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3657 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3658 }
3659 return ret;
3660 }
3661
3662 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Warn if
3663 there are conflicting attributes. */
3664 static bfd_boolean
3665 ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3666 {
3667 bfd *obfd;
3668 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3669 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3670 bfd_boolean ret;
3671
3672 if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
3673 return FALSE;
3674
3675 obfd = info->output_bfd;
3676 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3677 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3678
3679 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
3680 merge non-conflicting ones. */
3681 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3682 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3683 ret = TRUE;
3684 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3685 {
3686 int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
3687 int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
3688 static bfd *last_vec;
3689
3690 if (in_vec == 0)
3691 ;
3692 else if (out_vec == 0)
3693 {
3694 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3695 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3696 last_vec = ibfd;
3697 }
3698 /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
3699 without a warning. If GCC marked files with their stack
3700 alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
3701 not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
3702 case too. */
3703 else if (in_vec == 1)
3704 ;
3705 else if (out_vec == 1)
3706 {
3707 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3708 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3709 last_vec = ibfd;
3710 }
3711 else if (out_vec < in_vec)
3712 {
3713 _bfd_error_handler
3714 /* xgettext:c-format */
3715 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3716 last_vec, ibfd);
3717 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3718 ret = FALSE;
3719 }
3720 else if (out_vec > in_vec)
3721 {
3722 _bfd_error_handler
3723 /* xgettext:c-format */
3724 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3725 ibfd, last_vec);
3726 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3727 ret = FALSE;
3728 }
3729 }
3730
3731 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
3732 and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3733 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3734 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3735 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3736 {
3737 int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
3738 int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
3739 static bfd *last_struct;
3740
3741 if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
3742 ;
3743 else if (out_struct == 0)
3744 {
3745 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3746 out_attr->i = in_struct;
3747 last_struct = ibfd;
3748 }
3749 else if (out_struct < in_struct)
3750 {
3751 _bfd_error_handler
3752 /* xgettext:c-format */
3753 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3754 "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
3755 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3756 ret = FALSE;
3757 }
3758 else if (out_struct > in_struct)
3759 {
3760 _bfd_error_handler
3761 /* xgettext:c-format */
3762 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3763 "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
3764 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3765 ret = FALSE;
3766 }
3767 }
3768 if (!ret)
3769 {
3770 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3771 return FALSE;
3772 }
3773
3774 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
3775 return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
3776 }
3777
3778 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3779 object file when linking. */
3780
3781 static bfd_boolean
3782 ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3783 {
3784 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3785 flagword old_flags;
3786 flagword new_flags;
3787 bfd_boolean error;
3788
3789 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
3790 return TRUE;
3791
3792 /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
3793 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3794 return FALSE;
3795
3796 if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
3797 return FALSE;
3798
3799 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3800 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3801 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
3802 {
3803 /* First call, no flags set. */
3804 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
3805 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
3806 }
3807
3808 /* Compatible flags are ok. */
3809 else if (new_flags == old_flags)
3810 ;
3811
3812 /* Incompatible flags. */
3813 else
3814 {
3815 /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch. Allow -mrelocatable-lib
3816 to be linked with either. */
3817 error = FALSE;
3818 if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
3819 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
3820 {
3821 error = TRUE;
3822 _bfd_error_handler
3823 (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
3824 "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
3825 }
3826 else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
3827 && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
3828 {
3829 error = TRUE;
3830 _bfd_error_handler
3831 (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
3832 "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
3833 }
3834
3835 /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are. */
3836 if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
3837 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
3838
3839 /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
3840 but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib. */
3841 if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
3842 && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
3843 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
3844 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
3845
3846 /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
3847 any module uses it. */
3848 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
3849
3850 new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3851 old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3852
3853 /* Warn about any other mismatches. */
3854 if (new_flags != old_flags)
3855 {
3856 error = TRUE;
3857 _bfd_error_handler
3858 /* xgettext:c-format */
3859 (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
3860 "than previous modules (%#x)"),
3861 ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
3862 }
3863
3864 if (error)
3865 {
3866 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3867 return FALSE;
3868 }
3869 }
3870
3871 return TRUE;
3872 }
3873
3874 static void
3875 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
3876 asection *input_section,
3877 unsigned long offset,
3878 bfd_byte *loc,
3879 bfd_vma value,
3880 split16_format_type split16_format,
3881 bfd_boolean fixup)
3882 {
3883 unsigned int insn, opcode;
3884
3885 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
3886 opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
3887 if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
3888 || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
3889 || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
3890 || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
3891 || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
3892 {
3893 if (split16_format != split16a_type)
3894 {
3895 if (fixup)
3896 split16_format = split16a_type;
3897 else
3898 _bfd_error_handler
3899 /* xgettext:c-format */
3900 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3901 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3902 }
3903 }
3904 else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
3905 || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
3906 || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
3907 || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
3908 || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
3909 || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
3910 || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
3911 {
3912 if (split16_format != split16d_type)
3913 {
3914 if (fixup)
3915 split16_format = split16d_type;
3916 else
3917 _bfd_error_handler
3918 /* xgettext:c-format */
3919 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3920 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3921 }
3922 }
3923 if (split16_format == split16a_type)
3924 {
3925 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
3926 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3927 if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
3928 {
3929 /* Hack for e_li. Extend sign. */
3930 insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
3931 insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3932 }
3933 }
3934 else
3935 {
3936 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
3937 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
3938 }
3939 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3940 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
3941 }
3942
3943 static void
3944 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
3945 {
3946 unsigned int insn;
3947
3948 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
3949 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
3950 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
3951 insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3952 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
3953 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3954 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
3955 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3956 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
3957 }
3958
3959 \f
3960 /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
3961 Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT. */
3962 int
3963 ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3964 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3965 {
3966 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3967 flagword flags;
3968
3969 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
3970
3971 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3972 {
3973 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3974
3975 if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
3976 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3977 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3978 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3979 && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
3980 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE)) != NULL
3981 && (h->type == STT_FUNC
3982 || h->needs_plt)
3983 && h->ref_regular
3984 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
3985 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
3986 {
3987 /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
3988 secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
3989 function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
3990 r30 to be set up. */
3991 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3992 }
3993 else
3994 {
3995 bfd *ibfd;
3996 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
3997
3998 /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
3999 Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
4000 without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
4001 --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs. */
4002 if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
4003 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4004 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4005 if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4006 {
4007 if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
4008 plt_type = PLT_NEW;
4009 else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
4010 {
4011 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4012 htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
4013 break;
4014 }
4015 }
4016 htab->plt_type = plt_type;
4017 }
4018 }
4019 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD && htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW)
4020 {
4021 if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
4022 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
4023 else
4024 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
4025 }
4026
4027 BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
4028
4029 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
4030 {
4031 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4032 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4033
4034 /* The new PLT is a loaded section. */
4035 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
4036 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.splt, flags))
4037 return -1;
4038
4039 /* The new GOT is not executable. */
4040 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
4041 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
4042 return -1;
4043 }
4044 else
4045 {
4046 /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment. */
4047 if (htab->glink != NULL
4048 && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 0))
4049 return -1;
4050 }
4051 return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
4052 }
4053 \f
4054 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
4055 relocation. */
4056
4057 static asection *
4058 ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
4059 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4060 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4061 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4062 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
4063 {
4064 if (h != NULL)
4065 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
4066 {
4067 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4068 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
4069 return NULL;
4070 }
4071
4072 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
4073 }
4074
4075 static bfd_boolean
4076 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
4077 Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
4078 asection **symsecp,
4079 unsigned char **tls_maskp,
4080 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
4081 unsigned long r_symndx,
4082 bfd *ibfd)
4083 {
4084 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4085
4086 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4087 {
4088 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4089 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4090
4091 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4092 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4093 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4094 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4095
4096 if (hp != NULL)
4097 *hp = h;
4098
4099 if (symp != NULL)
4100 *symp = NULL;
4101
4102 if (symsecp != NULL)
4103 {
4104 asection *symsec = NULL;
4105 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4106 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4107 symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
4108 *symsecp = symsec;
4109 }
4110
4111 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4112 *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4113 }
4114 else
4115 {
4116 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4117 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
4118
4119 if (locsyms == NULL)
4120 {
4121 locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
4122 if (locsyms == NULL)
4123 locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
4124 symtab_hdr->sh_info,
4125 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
4126 if (locsyms == NULL)
4127 return FALSE;
4128 *locsymsp = locsyms;
4129 }
4130 sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
4131
4132 if (hp != NULL)
4133 *hp = NULL;
4134
4135 if (symp != NULL)
4136 *symp = sym;
4137
4138 if (symsecp != NULL)
4139 *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
4140
4141 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4142 {
4143 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
4144 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4145
4146 tls_mask = NULL;
4147 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4148 if (local_got != NULL)
4149 {
4150 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4151 (local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4152 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4153 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4154 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4155 }
4156 *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
4157 }
4158 }
4159 return TRUE;
4160 }
4161 \f
4162 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
4163 defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
4164
4165 bfd_boolean
4166 ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4167 {
4168 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4169 bfd *ibfd;
4170 asection *sec;
4171 bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
4172
4173 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4174 if (htab == NULL)
4175 return FALSE;
4176
4177 /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
4178 reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
4179 between the call and its destination. */
4180 limit = 0x1e00000;
4181 low_vma = -1;
4182 high_vma = 0;
4183 for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4184 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
4185 {
4186 if (low_vma > sec->vma)
4187 low_vma = sec->vma;
4188 if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
4189 high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
4190 }
4191
4192 /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
4193 convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
4194 is local. */
4195 if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
4196 {
4197 htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
4198 return TRUE;
4199 }
4200
4201 /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
4202 call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
4203 the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
4204 this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
4205 will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
4206 particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
4207 difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
4208 linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
4209 particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
4210 call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
4211 the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
4212 together except their symbol. */
4213
4214 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4215 {
4216 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4217 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
4218
4219 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4220 continue;
4221
4222 local_syms = NULL;
4223 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4224
4225 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4226 if (sec->has_pltcall
4227 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4228 {
4229 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4230
4231 /* Read the relocations. */
4232 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4233 info->keep_memory);
4234 if (relstart == NULL)
4235 return FALSE;
4236
4237 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4238 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
4239 {
4240 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4241 unsigned long r_symndx;
4242 asection *sym_sec;
4243 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4244 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4245 unsigned char *tls_maskp;
4246
4247 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4248 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
4249 continue;
4250
4251 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4252 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
4253 r_symndx, ibfd))
4254 {
4255 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4256 free (relstart);
4257 if (local_syms != NULL
4258 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4259 free (local_syms);
4260 return FALSE;
4261 }
4262
4263 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
4264 {
4265 bfd_vma from, to;
4266 if (h != NULL)
4267 to = h->root.u.def.value;
4268 else
4269 to = sym->st_value;
4270 to += (rel->r_addend
4271 + sym_sec->output_offset
4272 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
4273 from = (rel->r_offset
4274 + sec->output_offset
4275 + sec->output_section->vma);
4276 if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
4277 *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
4278 }
4279 }
4280 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4281 free (relstart);
4282 }
4283
4284 if (local_syms != NULL
4285 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4286 {
4287 if (!info->keep_memory)
4288 free (local_syms);
4289 else
4290 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
4291 }
4292 }
4293
4294 return TRUE;
4295 }
4296
4297 /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
4298 generic ELF tls_setup function. */
4299
4300 asection *
4301 ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4302 {
4303 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4304
4305 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4306 htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4307 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4308 if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
4309 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4310
4311 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
4312 {
4313 struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
4314 opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
4315 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4316 if (opt != NULL
4317 && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4318 || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
4319 {
4320 /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
4321 signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
4322 be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
4323 make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
4324 tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
4325 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
4326 && tga != NULL
4327 && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
4328 || tga->needs_plt)
4329 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
4330 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
4331 {
4332 struct plt_entry *ent;
4333 for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4334 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4335 break;
4336 if (ent != NULL)
4337 {
4338 tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
4339 tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
4340 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
4341 opt->mark = 1;
4342 if (opt->dynindx != -1)
4343 {
4344 /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
4345 opt->dynindx = -1;
4346 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4347 opt->dynstr_index);
4348 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
4349 return FALSE;
4350 }
4351 htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
4352 }
4353 }
4354 }
4355 else
4356 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4357 }
4358 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
4359 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
4360 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
4361 {
4362 elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
4363 elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
4364 }
4365
4366 return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
4367 }
4368
4369 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
4370 HASH. */
4371
4372 static bfd_boolean
4373 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
4374 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4375 const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
4376 {
4377 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4378 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4379 unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4380
4381 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4382 {
4383 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4384 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4385
4386 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4387 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4388 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4389 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4390 if (h == hash)
4391 return TRUE;
4392 }
4393 return FALSE;
4394 }
4395
4396 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
4397 opportunities. */
4398
4399 bfd_boolean
4400 ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4401 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4402 {
4403 bfd *ibfd;
4404 asection *sec;
4405 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4406 int pass;
4407
4408 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4409 return TRUE;
4410
4411 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4412 if (htab == NULL)
4413 return FALSE;
4414
4415 /* Make two passes through the relocs. First time check that tls
4416 relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
4417 followed by such a call. If they are not, don't do any tls
4418 optimization. On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
4419 notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
4420 adjust got and plt refcounts. */
4421 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
4422 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4423 {
4424 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4425 asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
4426
4427 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4428 if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4429 {
4430 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4431 int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4432
4433 /* Read the relocations. */
4434 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4435 info->keep_memory);
4436 if (relstart == NULL)
4437 return FALSE;
4438
4439 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4440 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4441 {
4442 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4443 unsigned long r_symndx;
4444 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4445 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4446 unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
4447 bfd_boolean is_local;
4448 bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
4449
4450 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4451 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4452 {
4453 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4454
4455 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4456 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4457 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4458 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4459 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4460 }
4461
4462 is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
4463 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4464 /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4465 without marker relocs, then check that each
4466 __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
4467 that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
4468 setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
4469 relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
4470 if (pass == 0
4471 && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4472 && h != NULL
4473 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
4474 && !expecting_tls_get_addr
4475 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4476 {
4477 info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
4478 "TLS optimization disabled\n",
4479 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4480 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4481 free (relstart);
4482 return TRUE;
4483 }
4484
4485 expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4486 switch (r_type)
4487 {
4488 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
4489 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4490 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4491 /* Fall through. */
4492
4493 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4494 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4495 /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
4496 defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
4497 that turns out to be the case. */
4498 if (!is_local)
4499 continue;
4500
4501 /* LD -> LE */
4502 tls_set = 0;
4503 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
4504 break;
4505
4506 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
4507 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4508 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4509 /* Fall through. */
4510
4511 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4512 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4513 if (is_local)
4514 /* GD -> LE */
4515 tls_set = 0;
4516 else
4517 /* GD -> IE */
4518 tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
4519 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
4520 break;
4521
4522 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
4523 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
4524 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4525 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4526 if (is_local)
4527 {
4528 /* IE -> LE */
4529 tls_set = 0;
4530 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
4531 break;
4532 }
4533 else
4534 continue;
4535
4536 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
4537 if (!is_local)
4538 continue;
4539 /* Fall through. */
4540 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
4541 if (rel + 1 < relend
4542 && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
4543 {
4544 if (pass != 0
4545 && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
4546 {
4547 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
4548 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
4549 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4550 {
4551 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4552
4553 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4554 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4555 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4556 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4557 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4558 if (h != NULL)
4559 {
4560 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
4561 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4562
4563 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4564 addend = rel->r_addend;
4565 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
4566 got2, addend);
4567 if (ent != NULL
4568 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4569 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4570 }
4571 }
4572 }
4573 continue;
4574 }
4575 expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
4576 tls_set = 0;
4577 tls_clear = 0;
4578 break;
4579
4580 default:
4581 continue;
4582 }
4583
4584 if (pass == 0)
4585 {
4586 if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
4587 || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4588 continue;
4589
4590 if (rel + 1 < relend
4591 && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
4592 htab->tls_get_addr))
4593 continue;
4594
4595 /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
4596 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
4597 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
4598 the entire optimization. */
4599 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
4600 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
4601 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4602 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4603 free (relstart);
4604 return TRUE;
4605 }
4606
4607 if (h != NULL)
4608 {
4609 tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4610 got_count = &h->got.refcount;
4611 }
4612 else
4613 {
4614 bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
4615 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4616 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
4617
4618 lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4619 if (lgot_refs == NULL)
4620 abort ();
4621 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4622 (lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4623 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4624 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4625 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4626 got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
4627 }
4628
4629 /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4630 without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
4631 found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
4632 marker for this symbol, then we either have a
4633 broken object file or an -mlongcall style
4634 indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
4635 Disable optimization in this case. */
4636 if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
4637 && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4638 && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4639 != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
4640 continue;
4641
4642 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 1 + !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4643 {
4644 struct plt_entry *ent;
4645 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4646
4647 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
4648 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
4649 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
4650 addend = rel[1].r_addend;
4651 ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
4652 got2, addend);
4653 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4654 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4655 }
4656 if (tls_clear == 0)
4657 continue;
4658
4659 if (tls_set == 0)
4660 {
4661 /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
4662 if (*got_count > 0)
4663 *got_count -= 1;
4664 }
4665
4666 *tls_mask |= tls_set;
4667 *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
4668 }
4669
4670 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4671 free (relstart);
4672 }
4673 }
4674 htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
4675 return TRUE;
4676 }
4677 \f
4678 /* Find dynamic relocs for H that apply to read-only sections. */
4679
4680 static asection *
4681 readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4682 {
4683 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4684
4685 for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4686 {
4687 asection *s = p->sec->output_section;
4688
4689 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4690 return p->sec;
4691 }
4692 return NULL;
4693 }
4694
4695 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
4696 aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
4697 size_dynamic_sections. */
4698
4699 static bfd_boolean
4700 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4701 {
4702 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4703 do
4704 {
4705 if (readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
4706 return TRUE;
4707 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
4708 } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
4709
4710 return FALSE;
4711 }
4712
4713 /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
4714
4715 static bfd_boolean
4716 pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4717 {
4718 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4719
4720 for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4721 if (p->pc_count != 0)
4722 return TRUE;
4723 return FALSE;
4724 }
4725
4726 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
4727 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
4728 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
4729 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
4730 understand. */
4731
4732 static bfd_boolean
4733 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4734 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4735 {
4736 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4737 asection *s;
4738
4739 #ifdef DEBUG
4740 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
4741 h->root.root.string);
4742 #endif
4743
4744 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
4745 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4746 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
4747 && (h->needs_plt
4748 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4749 || h->is_weakalias
4750 || (h->def_dynamic
4751 && h->ref_regular
4752 && !h->def_regular)));
4753
4754 /* Deal with function syms. */
4755 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
4756 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4757 || h->needs_plt)
4758 {
4759 bfd_boolean local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4760 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
4761 /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
4762 function symbol is local. */
4763 if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
4764 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4765
4766 /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
4767 won't need a .plt entry. */
4768 struct plt_entry *ent;
4769 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4770 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4771 break;
4772 if (ent == NULL
4773 || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
4774 && local
4775 && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
4776 || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
4777 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
4778 {
4779 /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
4780
4781 1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
4782 can't be set up, so we can't use one. In this case,
4783 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
4784
4785 2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
4786
4787 3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
4788 will go to this object, or will remain undefined. */
4789 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4790 h->needs_plt = 0;
4791 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4792 }
4793 else
4794 {
4795 /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
4796 doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
4797 executable on a plt call stub. A dynamic reloc can
4798 be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
4799 (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
4800 through the plt call stub.) Similarly, use a dynamic
4801 reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
4802 resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
4803 than link time. */
4804 if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
4805 || (h->non_got_ref
4806 && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
4807 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4808 && !htab->is_vxworks
4809 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4810 && !readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4811 {
4812 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4813 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
4814 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
4815 if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4816 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4817 }
4818 else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
4819 /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
4820 plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
4821 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4822 }
4823 h->protected_def = 0;
4824 /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
4825 return TRUE;
4826 }
4827 else
4828 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4829
4830 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
4831 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
4832 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
4833 if (h->is_weakalias)
4834 {
4835 struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
4836 BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
4837 h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
4838 h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
4839 if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
4840 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
4841 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
4842 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4843 return TRUE;
4844 }
4845
4846 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
4847 is not a function. */
4848
4849 /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
4850 only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
4851 For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
4852 be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
4853 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4854 {
4855 h->protected_def = 0;
4856 return TRUE;
4857 }
4858
4859 /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
4860 GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
4861 if (!h->non_got_ref)
4862 {
4863 h->protected_def = 0;
4864 return TRUE;
4865 }
4866
4867 /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
4868 .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
4869 definition for the variable. Editing to PIC, or text relocations
4870 are preferable to an incorrect program. */
4871 if (h->protected_def)
4872 {
4873 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4874 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
4875 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
4876 && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
4877 && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
4878 htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
4879 return TRUE;
4880 }
4881
4882 /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either. */
4883 if (info->nocopyreloc)
4884 return TRUE;
4885
4886 /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
4887 we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
4888 We can't do this if there are any small data relocations. This
4889 doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
4890 relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
4891 executable. */
4892 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4893 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4894 && !htab->is_vxworks
4895 && !h->def_regular
4896 && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4897 return TRUE;
4898
4899 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
4900 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
4901 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
4902 object will contain position independent code, so all references
4903 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
4904 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
4905 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
4906 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
4907 same memory location for the variable.
4908
4909 Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
4910 must instead allocate it in .sbss. */
4911 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4912 s = htab->dynsbss;
4913 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4914 s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
4915 else
4916 s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
4917 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4918
4919 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
4920 {
4921 asection *srel;
4922
4923 /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
4924 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
4925 and into the runtime process image. */
4926 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4927 srel = htab->relsbss;
4928 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4929 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
4930 else
4931 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
4932 BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
4933 srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4934 h->needs_copy = 1;
4935 }
4936
4937 /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
4938 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4939 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
4940 }
4941 \f
4942 /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs. For non-PIC code the sym is
4943 xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
4944 specifying the addend on the plt relocation. For -fpic code, the sym
4945 is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
4946 xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>. */
4947
4948 static bfd_boolean
4949 add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
4950 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4951 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4952 {
4953 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
4954 size_t len1, len2, len3;
4955 char *name;
4956 const char *stub;
4957 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4958
4959 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4960 stub = ".plt_pic32.";
4961 else
4962 stub = ".plt_call32.";
4963
4964 len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
4965 len2 = strlen (stub);
4966 len3 = 0;
4967 if (ent->sec)
4968 len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
4969 name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
4970 if (name == NULL)
4971 return FALSE;
4972 sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
4973 if (ent->sec)
4974 memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
4975 memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
4976 memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
4977 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
4978 if (sh == NULL)
4979 return FALSE;
4980 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
4981 {
4982 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
4983 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
4984 sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
4985 sh->ref_regular = 1;
4986 sh->def_regular = 1;
4987 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
4988 sh->forced_local = 1;
4989 sh->non_elf = 0;
4990 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
4991 }
4992 return TRUE;
4993 }
4994
4995 /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
4996 Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k. */
4997
4998 static bfd_vma
4999 allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
5000 {
5001 bfd_vma where;
5002 unsigned int max_before_header;
5003
5004 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5005 {
5006 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5007 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5008 }
5009 else
5010 {
5011 max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
5012 if (need <= htab->got_gap)
5013 {
5014 where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
5015 htab->got_gap -= need;
5016 }
5017 else
5018 {
5019 if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
5020 && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
5021 {
5022 htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
5023 htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
5024 }
5025 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5026 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5027 }
5028 }
5029 return where;
5030 }
5031
5032 /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
5033 TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot. */
5034
5035 static inline unsigned int
5036 got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
5037 {
5038 unsigned int need;
5039 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
5040 need = 4;
5041 else
5042 {
5043 need = 0;
5044 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
5045 need += 8;
5046 if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5047 need += 4;
5048 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
5049 need += 4;
5050 }
5051 return need;
5052 }
5053
5054 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
5055
5056 static bfd_boolean
5057 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5058 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5059 {
5060 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
5061
5062 if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
5063 && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
5064 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5065 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
5066 && h->dynindx == -1
5067 && !h->forced_local
5068 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5069 return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
5070 return TRUE;
5071 }
5072
5073 /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs. */
5074
5075 static bfd_boolean
5076 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5077 {
5078 struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
5079 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
5080 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5081 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5082 bfd_boolean dyn;
5083
5084 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5085 return TRUE;
5086
5087 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5088 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5089 if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
5090 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
5091 && !eh->elf.def_regular
5092 && eh->elf.protected_def
5093 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5094 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5095 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5096 {
5097 unsigned int need;
5098
5099 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5100 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
5101 return FALSE;
5102
5103 need = 0;
5104 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5105 {
5106 if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
5107 /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset. This should
5108 always be the case. It's a little odd if we have
5109 a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol. */
5110 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5111 else
5112 need += 8;
5113 }
5114 need += got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
5115 if (need == 0)
5116 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5117 else
5118 {
5119 eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
5120 if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
5121 && !((eh->tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
5122 && bfd_link_executable (info)
5123 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5124 || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5125 && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
5126 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5127 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
5128 {
5129 asection *rsec;
5130
5131 need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5132 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5133 need -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5134 rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
5135 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5136 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
5137 rsec->size += need;
5138 }
5139 }
5140 }
5141 else
5142 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5143
5144 /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
5145 IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
5146 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5147 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5148 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5149
5150 /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
5151 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5152 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5153 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5154
5155 /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
5156 visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
5157 else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
5158 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5159
5160 if (eh->dyn_relocs == NULL)
5161 ;
5162
5163 /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
5164 dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
5165 defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case, discard
5166 space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
5167 changes. */
5168 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5169 {
5170 /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
5171 or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
5172 generated via assembly. We want calls to protected symbols to
5173 resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
5174 If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
5175 then they should avoid writing weird assembly. */
5176 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
5177 {
5178 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5179
5180 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5181 {
5182 p->count -= p->pc_count;
5183 p->pc_count = 0;
5184 if (p->count == 0)
5185 *pp = p->next;
5186 else
5187 pp = &p->next;
5188 }
5189 }
5190
5191 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5192 {
5193 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5194
5195 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5196 {
5197 if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
5198 *pp = p->next;
5199 else
5200 pp = &p->next;
5201 }
5202 }
5203
5204 if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
5205 {
5206 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5207 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5208 return FALSE;
5209 }
5210 }
5211 else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
5212 {
5213 /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
5214 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
5215 dynamic. */
5216 if (h->dynamic_adjusted
5217 && !h->def_regular
5218 && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
5219 && !(h->protected_def
5220 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5221 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5222 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5223 {
5224 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5225 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5226 return FALSE;
5227
5228 if (h->dynindx == -1)
5229 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5230 }
5231 else
5232 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5233 }
5234
5235 /* Allocate space. */
5236 for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5237 {
5238 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5239 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5240 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5241 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5242 }
5243
5244 /* Handle PLT relocs. Done last, after dynindx has settled.
5245 We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
5246 a) is dynamic, or
5247 b) is an ifunc, or
5248 c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
5249 d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
5250 dyn = htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1;
5251 if (dyn
5252 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5253 || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
5254 || (h->needs_plt
5255 && h->def_regular
5256 && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5257 && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5258 && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
5259 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
5260 {
5261 struct plt_entry *ent;
5262 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5263 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5264
5265 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5266 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5267 {
5268 asection *s = htab->elf.splt;
5269
5270 if (!dyn)
5271 {
5272 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5273 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5274 else
5275 s = htab->pltlocal;
5276 }
5277
5278 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
5279 {
5280 if (!doneone)
5281 {
5282 plt_offset = s->size;
5283 s->size += 4;
5284 }
5285 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5286
5287 if (s == htab->pltlocal)
5288 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5289 else
5290 {
5291 s = htab->glink;
5292 if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
5293 {
5294 glink_offset = s->size;
5295 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
5296 }
5297 if (!doneone
5298 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
5299 && h->def_dynamic
5300 && !h->def_regular)
5301 {
5302 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5303 h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
5304 }
5305 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5306
5307 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
5308 && !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
5309 return FALSE;
5310 }
5311 }
5312 else
5313 {
5314 if (!doneone)
5315 {
5316 /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
5317 for the special first entry. */
5318 if (s->size == 0)
5319 s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
5320
5321 /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
5322 parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
5323 and a jump), and then there is a remaining
5324 word available at the end. */
5325 plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
5326 + (htab->plt_slot_size
5327 * ((s->size
5328 - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5329 / htab->plt_entry_size)));
5330
5331 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
5332 file, and we are not generating a shared
5333 library, then set the symbol to this location
5334 in the .plt. This is to avoid text
5335 relocations, and is required to make
5336 function pointers compare as equal between
5337 the normal executable and the shared library. */
5338 if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
5339 && h->def_dynamic
5340 && !h->def_regular)
5341 {
5342 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5343 h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
5344 }
5345
5346 /* Make room for this entry. */
5347 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5348 /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
5349 is allocated. */
5350 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
5351 && (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5352 / htab->plt_entry_size
5353 > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
5354 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5355 }
5356 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5357 }
5358
5359 /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
5360 if (!doneone)
5361 {
5362 if (!dyn)
5363 {
5364 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5365 {
5366 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5367 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5368 }
5369 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5370 {
5371 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5372 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5373 }
5374 }
5375 else
5376 {
5377 htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5378
5379 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5380 {
5381 /* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations. */
5382 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5383 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5384 {
5385 if (ent->plt.offset
5386 == (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5387 {
5388 htab->srelplt2->size
5389 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5390 * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
5391 }
5392
5393 htab->srelplt2->size
5394 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5395 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
5396 }
5397
5398 /* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
5399 .got.plt. */
5400 htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
5401 }
5402 }
5403 doneone = TRUE;
5404 }
5405 }
5406 else
5407 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5408
5409 if (!doneone)
5410 {
5411 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5412 h->needs_plt = 0;
5413 }
5414 }
5415 else
5416 {
5417 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5418 h->needs_plt = 0;
5419 }
5420
5421 return TRUE;
5422 }
5423
5424 /* Set DF_TEXTREL if we find any dynamic relocs that apply to
5425 read-only sections. */
5426
5427 static bfd_boolean
5428 maybe_set_textrel (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *info_p)
5429 {
5430 asection *sec;
5431
5432 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5433 return TRUE;
5434
5435 sec = readonly_dynrelocs (h);
5436 if (sec != NULL)
5437 {
5438 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) info_p;
5439
5440 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5441 info->callbacks->minfo
5442 (_("%pB: dynamic relocation against `%pT' in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5443 sec->owner, h->root.root.string, sec);
5444
5445 /* Not an error, just cut short the traversal. */
5446 return FALSE;
5447 }
5448 return TRUE;
5449 }
5450
5451 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
5452 {
5453 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
5454 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
5455 1, /* CIE version. */
5456 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
5457 4, /* Code alignment. */
5458 0x7c, /* Data alignment. */
5459 65, /* RA reg. */
5460 1, /* Augmentation size. */
5461 DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
5462 DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
5463 };
5464
5465 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
5466
5467 static bfd_boolean
5468 ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5469 struct bfd_link_info *info)
5470 {
5471 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5472 asection *s;
5473 bfd_boolean relocs;
5474 bfd *ibfd;
5475
5476 #ifdef DEBUG
5477 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
5478 #endif
5479
5480 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5481 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
5482
5483 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5484 {
5485 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
5486 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
5487 {
5488 s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
5489 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5490 s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5491 s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5492 }
5493 }
5494
5495 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5496 htab->got_header_size = 16;
5497 else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
5498 htab->got_header_size = 12;
5499
5500 /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
5501 relocs. */
5502 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
5503 {
5504 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
5505 bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
5506 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
5507 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
5508 char *lgot_masks;
5509 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
5510 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5511
5512 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
5513 continue;
5514
5515 for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5516 {
5517 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5518
5519 for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
5520 elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
5521 p != NULL;
5522 p = p->next)
5523 {
5524 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
5525 && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
5526 {
5527 /* Input section has been discarded, either because
5528 it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
5529 linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
5530 the relocs too. */
5531 }
5532 else if (htab->is_vxworks
5533 && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
5534 ".tls_vars") == 0)
5535 {
5536 /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
5537 handled specially by the loader. */
5538 }
5539 else if (p->count != 0)
5540 {
5541 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5542 if (p->ifunc)
5543 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5544 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5545 if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
5546 & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5547 == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5548 {
5549 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5550 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5551 p->sec->owner, p->sec);
5552 }
5553 }
5554 }
5555 }
5556
5557 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
5558 if (!local_got)
5559 continue;
5560
5561 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
5562 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5563 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
5564 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
5565 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
5566 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5567
5568 for (; local_got < end_local_got; ++local_got, ++lgot_masks)
5569 if (*local_got > 0)
5570 {
5571 unsigned int need;
5572 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5573 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5574 need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
5575 if (need == 0)
5576 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5577 else
5578 {
5579 *local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
5580 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5581 && !((*lgot_masks & TLS_TLS) != 0
5582 && bfd_link_executable (info)))
5583 {
5584 asection *srel;
5585
5586 need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5587 srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
5588 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5589 srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
5590 srel->size += need;
5591 }
5592 }
5593 }
5594 else
5595 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5596
5597 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5598 continue;
5599
5600 /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt. */
5601 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5602 for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
5603 {
5604 struct plt_entry *ent;
5605 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5606 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5607
5608 for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5609 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5610 {
5611 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5612 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5613 else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5614 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
5615 {
5616 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5617 continue;
5618 }
5619 else
5620 s = htab->pltlocal;
5621
5622 if (!doneone)
5623 {
5624 plt_offset = s->size;
5625 s->size += 4;
5626 }
5627 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5628
5629 if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
5630 {
5631 s = htab->glink;
5632 glink_offset = s->size;
5633 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
5634 }
5635 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5636
5637 if (!doneone)
5638 {
5639 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5640 {
5641 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5642 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5643 }
5644 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5645 {
5646 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5647 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5648 }
5649 doneone = TRUE;
5650 }
5651 }
5652 else
5653 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5654 }
5655 }
5656
5657 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
5658 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
5659
5660 if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
5661 {
5662 htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
5663 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5664 htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5665 }
5666 else
5667 htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5668
5669 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
5670 {
5671 unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
5672
5673 /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now. When we get here,
5674 for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
5675 or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated). For new plt/got, the
5676 corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536. */
5677 if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
5678 {
5679 g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5680 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5681 g_o_t += 4;
5682 htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
5683 }
5684
5685 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
5686 }
5687 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5688 {
5689 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5690
5691 sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
5692 sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
5693 }
5694 if (info->emitrelocations)
5695 {
5696 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5697
5698 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5699 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5700 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
5701 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5702 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5703 }
5704
5705 if (htab->glink != NULL
5706 && htab->glink->size != 0
5707 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5708 {
5709 htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
5710 /* Space for the branch table. */
5711 htab->glink->size
5712 += htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
5713 /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve. */
5714 htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
5715 ? 63 : 15);
5716 htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5717
5718 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
5719 {
5720 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
5721 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
5722 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5723 if (sh == NULL)
5724 return FALSE;
5725 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5726 {
5727 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5728 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5729 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
5730 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5731 sh->def_regular = 1;
5732 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5733 sh->forced_local = 1;
5734 sh->non_elf = 0;
5735 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5736 }
5737 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
5738 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5739 if (sh == NULL)
5740 return FALSE;
5741 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5742 {
5743 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5744 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5745 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5746 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5747 sh->def_regular = 1;
5748 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5749 sh->forced_local = 1;
5750 sh->non_elf = 0;
5751 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5752 }
5753 }
5754 }
5755
5756 if (htab->glink != NULL
5757 && htab->glink->size != 0
5758 && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5759 && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
5760 && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
5761 {
5762 s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
5763 s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
5764 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5765 {
5766 s->size += 4;
5767 if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
5768 s->size += 4;
5769 }
5770 }
5771
5772 /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
5773 Allocate memory for them. */
5774 relocs = FALSE;
5775 for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5776 {
5777 bfd_boolean strip_section = TRUE;
5778
5779 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5780 continue;
5781
5782 if (s == htab->elf.splt
5783 || s == htab->elf.sgot)
5784 {
5785 /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
5786 we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
5787 It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols. */
5788 if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
5789 strip_section = FALSE;
5790 /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
5791 comment below. */
5792 }
5793 else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
5794 || s == htab->pltlocal
5795 || s == htab->glink
5796 || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
5797 || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
5798 || s == htab->sbss
5799 || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
5800 || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
5801 || s == htab->dynsbss)
5802 {
5803 /* Strip these too. */
5804 }
5805 else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
5806 || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
5807 {
5808 strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
5809 }
5810 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (bfd_section_name (s), ".rela"))
5811 {
5812 if (s->size != 0)
5813 {
5814 /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections. */
5815 relocs = TRUE;
5816
5817 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5818 to copy relocs into the output file. */
5819 s->reloc_count = 0;
5820 }
5821 }
5822 else
5823 {
5824 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
5825 continue;
5826 }
5827
5828 if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
5829 {
5830 /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
5831 output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
5832 .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
5833 create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
5834 before the linker maps input sections to output
5835 sections. The linker does that before
5836 adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
5837 function which decides whether anything needs to go
5838 into these sections. */
5839 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5840 continue;
5841 }
5842
5843 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
5844 continue;
5845
5846 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
5847 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
5848 if (s->contents == NULL)
5849 return FALSE;
5850 }
5851
5852 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5853 {
5854 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
5855 values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
5856 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
5857 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
5858 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
5859 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
5860 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
5861
5862 if (bfd_link_executable (info))
5863 {
5864 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
5865 return FALSE;
5866 }
5867
5868 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
5869 {
5870 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
5871 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
5872 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
5873 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0))
5874 return FALSE;
5875 }
5876
5877 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
5878 && htab->glink != NULL
5879 && htab->glink->size != 0)
5880 {
5881 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
5882 return FALSE;
5883 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
5884 && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
5885 && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
5886 && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
5887 return FALSE;
5888 }
5889
5890 if (relocs)
5891 {
5892 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
5893 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
5894 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)))
5895 return FALSE;
5896 }
5897
5898 /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section, then we
5899 need a DT_TEXTREL entry. */
5900 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
5901 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), maybe_set_textrel,
5902 info);
5903
5904 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
5905 {
5906 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
5907 return FALSE;
5908 }
5909 if (htab->is_vxworks
5910 && !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
5911 return FALSE;
5912 }
5913 #undef add_dynamic_entry
5914
5915 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5916 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
5917 {
5918 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5919 bfd_vma val;
5920
5921 memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
5922 /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
5923 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
5924 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5925 /* FDE length. */
5926 val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5927 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5928 p += 4;
5929 /* CIE pointer. */
5930 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5931 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5932 p += 4;
5933 /* Offset to .glink. Set later. */
5934 p += 4;
5935 /* .glink size. */
5936 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
5937 p += 4;
5938 /* Augmentation. */
5939 p += 1;
5940
5941 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5942 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5943 {
5944 bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
5945 if (adv < 64)
5946 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
5947 else if (adv < 256)
5948 {
5949 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
5950 *p++ = adv;
5951 }
5952 else if (adv < 65536)
5953 {
5954 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
5955 bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5956 p += 2;
5957 }
5958 else
5959 {
5960 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
5961 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5962 p += 4;
5963 }
5964 *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
5965 *p++ = 65;
5966 p++;
5967 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
5968 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
5969 *p++ = 65;
5970 }
5971 BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
5972 == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
5973 }
5974
5975 return TRUE;
5976 }
5977
5978 /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
5979 if it looks like nothing is using them. */
5980
5981 static void
5982 maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
5983 {
5984 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
5985
5986 if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
5987 {
5988 asection *s;
5989
5990 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
5991 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
5992 {
5993 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
5994 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
5995 {
5996 sda->def_regular = 0;
5997 /* This is somewhat magic. See elf_link_output_extsym. */
5998 sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
5999 sda->forced_local = 0;
6000 }
6001 }
6002 }
6003 }
6004
6005 void
6006 ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
6007 {
6008 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6009
6010 if (htab != NULL)
6011 {
6012 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
6013 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
6014 }
6015 }
6016
6017
6018 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
6019
6020 static bfd_boolean
6021 ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6022 {
6023 if (h->plt.plist != NULL
6024 && !h->def_regular
6025 && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6026 || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
6027 return FALSE;
6028
6029 return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
6030 }
6031 \f
6032 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
6033
6034 /* Relaxation trampolines. r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
6035 used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI). */
6036 static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
6037 {
6038 0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
6039 0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
6040 0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
6041 0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
6042 0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
6043 0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
6044 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6045 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6046 };
6047
6048 static const int stub_entry[] =
6049 {
6050 0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
6051 0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
6052 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6053 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6054 };
6055
6056 struct ppc_elf_relax_info
6057 {
6058 unsigned int workaround_size;
6059 unsigned int picfixup_size;
6060 };
6061
6062 /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
6063 icache bug workaround. Any section needing trampolines or patch
6064 space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
6065 add trampolines at the end of the section. */
6066
6067 static bfd_boolean
6068 ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6069 asection *isec,
6070 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6071 bfd_boolean *again)
6072 {
6073 struct one_branch_fixup
6074 {
6075 struct one_branch_fixup *next;
6076 asection *tsec;
6077 /* Final link, can use the symbol offset. For a
6078 relocatable link we use the symbol's index. */
6079 bfd_vma toff;
6080 bfd_vma trampoff;
6081 };
6082
6083 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6084 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6085 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6086 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6087 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
6088 struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
6089 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6090 unsigned changes = 0;
6091 bfd_boolean workaround_change;
6092 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6093 bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
6094 asection *got2;
6095 bfd_boolean maybe_pasted;
6096
6097 *again = FALSE;
6098
6099 /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections. */
6100 if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
6101 || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
6102 || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
6103 || isec->size < 4)
6104 return TRUE;
6105
6106 /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
6107 do anything. The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
6108 anyway. */
6109 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6110 return TRUE;
6111
6112 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
6113 if (htab == NULL)
6114 return TRUE;
6115
6116 isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
6117 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6118 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6119 trampbase = isec->size;
6120
6121 BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
6122 || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
6123 isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
6124
6125 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6126 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6127 {
6128 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6129 {
6130 elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
6131 = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
6132 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6133 return FALSE;
6134 }
6135 relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
6136 trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
6137 }
6138
6139 maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
6140 || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
6141 /* Space for a branch around any trampolines. */
6142 trampoff = trampbase;
6143 if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
6144 trampoff += 4;
6145
6146 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
6147 picfixup_size = 0;
6148 if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
6149 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6150 {
6151 /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
6152 if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
6153 {
6154 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
6155 link_info->keep_memory);
6156 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6157 goto error_return;
6158 }
6159
6160 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
6161
6162 irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
6163 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6164 {
6165 unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
6166 bfd_vma toff, roff;
6167 asection *tsec;
6168 struct one_branch_fixup *f;
6169 size_t insn_offset = 0;
6170 bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val;
6171 bfd_byte *hit_addr;
6172 unsigned long t0;
6173 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6174 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6175 struct plt_entry **plist;
6176 unsigned char sym_type;
6177
6178 switch (r_type)
6179 {
6180 case R_PPC_REL24:
6181 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6182 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6183 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
6184 max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
6185 break;
6186
6187 case R_PPC_REL14:
6188 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6189 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6190 max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
6191 break;
6192
6193 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
6194 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6195 break;
6196 continue;
6197
6198 default:
6199 continue;
6200 }
6201
6202 /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
6203 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
6204 ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
6205 goto error_return;
6206
6207 if (isym != NULL)
6208 {
6209 if (tsec != NULL)
6210 ;
6211 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6212 tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6213 else
6214 continue;
6215
6216 toff = isym->st_value;
6217 sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
6218 }
6219 else
6220 {
6221 if (tsec != NULL)
6222 toff = h->root.u.def.value;
6223 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6224 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6225 {
6226 unsigned long indx;
6227
6228 indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6229 tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6230 toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
6231 }
6232 else
6233 continue;
6234
6235 /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
6236 optimise away the call. We won't be needing a long-
6237 branch stub in that case. */
6238 if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
6239 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6240 && irel != internal_relocs)
6241 {
6242 unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
6243 unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
6244 unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
6245
6246 /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
6247 R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
6248 on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn. Get tls
6249 mask bits from the symbol on that reloc. */
6250 if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6251 {
6252 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6253
6254 if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
6255 {
6256 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6257 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6258 char *lgot_masks = (char *)
6259 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6260 tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
6261 }
6262 }
6263 else
6264 {
6265 struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
6266 = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6267
6268 while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6269 || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6270 th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
6271
6272 tls_mask
6273 = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
6274 }
6275
6276 /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
6277 optimised away. */
6278 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
6279 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
6280 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
6281 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
6282 continue;
6283 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
6284 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
6285 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
6286 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
6287 continue;
6288 }
6289
6290 sym_type = h->type;
6291 }
6292
6293 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
6294 {
6295 if (h != NULL
6296 && !h->def_regular
6297 && h->protected_def
6298 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
6299 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
6300 picfixup_size += 12;
6301 continue;
6302 }
6303
6304 /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
6305 match that in relocate_section. If we call find_plt_ent here
6306 but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
6307 destination used here may be incorrect. */
6308 plist = NULL;
6309 if (h != NULL)
6310 {
6311 /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true. */
6312 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6313 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6314 plist = &h->plt.plist;
6315 }
6316 else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6317 && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
6318 {
6319 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6320 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6321 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6322 plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
6323 }
6324 if (plist != NULL)
6325 {
6326 bfd_vma addend = 0;
6327 struct plt_entry *ent;
6328
6329 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6330 addend = irel->r_addend;
6331 ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
6332 if (ent != NULL)
6333 {
6334 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
6335 || h == NULL
6336 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
6337 || h->dynindx == -1)
6338 {
6339 tsec = htab->glink;
6340 toff = ent->glink_offset;
6341 }
6342 else
6343 {
6344 tsec = htab->elf.splt;
6345 toff = ent->plt.offset;
6346 }
6347 }
6348 }
6349
6350 /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
6351 no hope of adding stubs. We'll error out later should the
6352 branch overflow. */
6353 if (tsec == isec)
6354 continue;
6355
6356 /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
6357 undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
6358 support addends. It would be possible to do so by
6359 putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
6360 branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting. */
6361 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6362 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
6363 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
6364 && irel->r_addend != 0)
6365 continue;
6366
6367 /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
6368 SEC_MERGE sections; SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
6369 attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
6370 branches. However, implement it correctly here as a
6371 reference for other target relax_section functions. */
6372 if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
6373 {
6374 /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
6375 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
6376 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset. (Later, in
6377 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
6378 section symbols have been adjusted.)
6379
6380 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
6381 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
6382 the original addend was zero. When the reloc is against
6383 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
6384 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
6385 location of interest is the original symbol. On the
6386 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
6387 a section symbol should not include the addend; Such an
6388 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym"; The
6389 location of interest is just "sym". */
6390 if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
6391 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6392 toff += irel->r_addend;
6393
6394 toff
6395 = _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
6396 elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
6397 toff);
6398
6399 if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
6400 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6401 toff += irel->r_addend;
6402 }
6403 /* PLTREL24 addends are special. */
6404 else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6405 toff += irel->r_addend;
6406
6407 /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses. */
6408 if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6409 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
6410 || tsec->output_section == NULL
6411 || (tsec->owner != NULL
6412 && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
6413 continue;
6414
6415 roff = irel->r_offset;
6416
6417 /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
6418 relocatable if the output section size is such that a
6419 fixup can be created at final link.
6420 The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
6421 of other fixups being needed at final link. */
6422 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6423 && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
6424 < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
6425 continue;
6426
6427 /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything. */
6428 if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
6429 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6430 /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
6431 final link, so do not presume they remain in range. */
6432 || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
6433 {
6434 bfd_vma symaddr, reladdr;
6435
6436 symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
6437 reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
6438 if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
6439 < 2 * max_branch_offset)
6440 continue;
6441 }
6442
6443 /* Look for an existing fixup to this address. */
6444 for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
6445 if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
6446 break;
6447
6448 if (f == NULL)
6449 {
6450 size_t size;
6451 unsigned long stub_rtype;
6452
6453 val = trampoff - roff;
6454 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6455 /* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline. Don't try to add
6456 one. We'll report an error later. */
6457 continue;
6458
6459 if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6460 {
6461 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
6462 insn_offset = 12;
6463 }
6464 else
6465 {
6466 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
6467 insn_offset = 0;
6468 }
6469 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
6470 if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
6471 || tsec == htab->glink)
6472 {
6473 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
6474 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6475 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
6476 }
6477
6478 /* Hijack the old relocation. Since we need two
6479 relocations for this use a "composite" reloc. */
6480 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
6481 stub_rtype);
6482 irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
6483 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
6484 && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
6485 irel->r_addend = 0;
6486
6487 /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section. */
6488 f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
6489 f->next = branch_fixups;
6490 f->tsec = tsec;
6491 f->toff = toff;
6492 f->trampoff = trampoff;
6493 branch_fixups = f;
6494
6495 trampoff += size;
6496 changes++;
6497 }
6498 else
6499 {
6500 val = f->trampoff - roff;
6501 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6502 continue;
6503
6504 /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here. */
6505 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6506 }
6507
6508 /* Get the section contents. */
6509 if (contents == NULL)
6510 {
6511 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6512 if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6513 contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
6514 /* Go get them off disk. */
6515 else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
6516 goto error_return;
6517 }
6518
6519 /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline. */
6520 hit_addr = contents + roff;
6521 switch (r_type)
6522 {
6523 case R_PPC_REL24:
6524 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6525 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6526 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6527 t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
6528 t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
6529 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6530 break;
6531
6532 case R_PPC_REL14:
6533 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6534 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6535 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6536 t0 &= ~0xfffc;
6537 t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
6538 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6539 break;
6540 }
6541 }
6542
6543 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6544 {
6545 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6546 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6547 free (f);
6548 }
6549 }
6550
6551 workaround_change = FALSE;
6552 newsize = trampoff;
6553 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6554 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6555 || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
6556 {
6557 bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
6558 unsigned int crossings;
6559 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6560
6561 addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
6562 end_addr = addr + trampoff;
6563 addr &= -pagesize;
6564 crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6565 if (crossings != 0)
6566 {
6567 /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
6568 not cross a page. Don't decrease size calculated on a
6569 previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout. */
6570 newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
6571 newsize += crossings * 16;
6572 if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
6573 {
6574 relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
6575 workaround_change = TRUE;
6576 }
6577 /* Ensure relocate_section is called. */
6578 isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
6579 }
6580 newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
6581 }
6582
6583 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6584 {
6585 picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
6586 if (picfixup_size != 0)
6587 relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
6588 newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
6589 }
6590
6591 if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
6592 isec->size = newsize;
6593
6594 if (isymbuf != NULL
6595 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
6596 {
6597 if (! link_info->keep_memory)
6598 free (isymbuf);
6599 else
6600 {
6601 /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6602 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6603 }
6604 }
6605
6606 if (contents != NULL
6607 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6608 {
6609 if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
6610 free (contents);
6611 else
6612 {
6613 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6614 elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6615 }
6616 }
6617
6618 changes += picfixup_size;
6619 if (changes != 0)
6620 {
6621 /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
6622 information for the trampolines. */
6623 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6624 Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
6625 * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6626 unsigned ix;
6627
6628 if (!new_relocs)
6629 goto error_return;
6630 memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
6631 isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6632 for (ix = changes; ix--;)
6633 {
6634 irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
6635
6636 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6637 }
6638 if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
6639 free (internal_relocs);
6640 elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
6641 isec->reloc_count += changes;
6642 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
6643 rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
6644 }
6645 else if (internal_relocs != NULL
6646 && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6647 free (internal_relocs);
6648
6649 *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
6650 return TRUE;
6651
6652 error_return:
6653 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6654 {
6655 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6656 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6657 free (f);
6658 }
6659 if (isymbuf != NULL && (unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
6660 free (isymbuf);
6661 if (contents != NULL
6662 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6663 free (contents);
6664 if (internal_relocs != NULL
6665 && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6666 free (internal_relocs);
6667 return FALSE;
6668 }
6669 \f
6670 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
6671 discarded sections. */
6672
6673 static unsigned int
6674 ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
6675 {
6676 if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
6677 return 0;
6678
6679 if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
6680 return 0;
6681
6682 return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
6683 }
6684 \f
6685 /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section. */
6686
6687 static bfd_vma
6688 elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
6689 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
6690 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6691 bfd_vma relocation,
6692 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6693 {
6694 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
6695
6696 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
6697
6698 if (h != NULL)
6699 {
6700 /* Handle global symbol. */
6701 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
6702
6703 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6704 BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
6705 linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
6706 }
6707 else
6708 {
6709 /* Handle local symbol. */
6710 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6711
6712 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
6713 BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
6714 linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
6715 }
6716
6717 linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
6718 rel->r_addend,
6719 lsect);
6720 BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
6721
6722 /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
6723 as a "written" flag. */
6724 if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
6725 {
6726 bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
6727 relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
6728 lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
6729 linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
6730 }
6731
6732 relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
6733 + lsect->section->output_offset
6734 + linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
6735 - SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
6736
6737 #ifdef DEBUG
6738 fprintf (stderr,
6739 "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
6740 lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
6741 #endif
6742
6743 return relocation;
6744 }
6745
6746 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
6747 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
6748 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
6749
6750 static void
6751 write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
6752 asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
6753 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6754 {
6755 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6756 bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
6757 bfd_vma plt;
6758 unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
6759
6760 if (h != NULL
6761 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6762 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
6763 {
6764 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
6765 p += 4;
6766 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
6767 p += 4;
6768 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
6769 p += 4;
6770 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
6771 p += 4;
6772 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
6773 p += 4;
6774 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
6775 p += 4;
6776 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
6777 p += 4;
6778 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
6779 p += 4;
6780 }
6781
6782 plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
6783 + plt_sec->output_section->vma
6784 + plt_sec->output_offset);
6785
6786 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6787 {
6788 bfd_vma got = 0;
6789
6790 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
6791 got = (ent->addend
6792 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
6793 + ent->sec->output_offset);
6794 else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6795 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
6796
6797 plt -= got;
6798
6799 if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
6800 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6801 else
6802 {
6803 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6804 p += 4;
6805 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6806 }
6807 }
6808 else
6809 {
6810 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6811 p += 4;
6812 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6813 }
6814 p += 4;
6815 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
6816 p += 4;
6817 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
6818 p += 4;
6819 while (p < end)
6820 {
6821 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
6822 p += 4;
6823 }
6824 }
6825
6826 /* Return true if symbol is defined statically. */
6827
6828 static bfd_boolean
6829 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6830 {
6831 return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6832 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6833 && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
6834 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
6835 }
6836
6837 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
6838 the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0. If
6839 REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG. */
6840
6841 unsigned int
6842 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6843 {
6844 unsigned int rtra;
6845
6846 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 31 << 26)
6847 return 0;
6848
6849 if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
6850 rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
6851 else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
6852 rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
6853 else
6854 return 0;
6855
6856 if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
6857 /* add -> addi. */
6858 insn = 14 << 26;
6859 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
6860 && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
6861 || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
6862 && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
6863 /* load and store indexed -> dform. */
6864 insn = (32u | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
6865 else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
6866 /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu. */
6867 insn = ((58u | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
6868 else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
6869 /* lwax -> lwa. */
6870 insn = (58u << 26) | 2;
6871 else
6872 return 0;
6873 insn |= rtra;
6874 return insn;
6875 }
6876
6877 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
6878 the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
6879 thread pointer REG operand removed. Otherwise return 0. */
6880
6881 unsigned int
6882 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6883 {
6884 if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
6885 && ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
6886 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
6887 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
6888 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
6889 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
6890 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
6891 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
6892 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
6893 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
6894 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
6895 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
6896 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
6897 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
6898 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
6899 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
6900 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
6901 && (insn & 3) != 1)
6902 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
6903 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
6904 {
6905 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
6906 }
6907 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
6908 && ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
6909 || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
6910 || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
6911 {
6912 insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
6913 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
6914 if ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
6915 insn -= 2 >> 26; /* convert to ori,oris */
6916 }
6917 else
6918 insn = 0;
6919 return insn;
6920 }
6921
6922 static bfd_boolean
6923 is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
6924 {
6925 return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
6926 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
6927 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
6928 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
6929 }
6930
6931 static bfd_boolean
6932 is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
6933 {
6934 return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
6935 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
6936 && (insn & 3) == 1));
6937 }
6938
6939 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
6940 to handle the relocations for a section.
6941
6942 The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
6943 actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
6944 zero.
6945
6946 This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
6947 necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
6948 relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
6949 necessary.
6950
6951 This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
6952 address or the reloc symbol index.
6953
6954 LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
6955
6956 LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
6957 corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
6958
6959 The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
6960 via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
6961
6962 When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
6963 STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
6964 going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
6965 section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
6966 accordingly. */
6967
6968 static bfd_boolean
6969 ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
6970 struct bfd_link_info *info,
6971 bfd *input_bfd,
6972 asection *input_section,
6973 bfd_byte *contents,
6974 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
6975 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
6976 asection **local_sections)
6977 {
6978 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6979 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
6980 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6981 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6982 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
6983 Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
6984 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
6985 asection *got2;
6986 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
6987 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
6988 bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
6989 bfd_boolean is_vxworks_tls;
6990 unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
6991 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6992
6993 #ifdef DEBUG
6994 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
6995 "%ld relocations%s",
6996 input_bfd, input_section,
6997 (long) input_section->reloc_count,
6998 (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
6999 #endif
7000
7001 if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
7002 {
7003 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
7004 return FALSE;
7005 }
7006
7007 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
7008
7009 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
7010 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
7011 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
7012
7013 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
7014 local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
7015 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
7016 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
7017 /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
7018 specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'. */
7019 is_vxworks_tls = (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
7020 && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
7021 ".tls_vars"));
7022 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
7023 relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
7024 rel = wrel = relocs;
7025 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
7026 for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
7027 {
7028 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
7029 bfd_vma addend;
7030 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
7031 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7032 asection *sec;
7033 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7034 const char *sym_name;
7035 reloc_howto_type *howto;
7036 unsigned long r_symndx;
7037 bfd_vma relocation;
7038 bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
7039 bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
7040 bfd_boolean warned;
7041 unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
7042 struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
7043 struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
7044
7045 again:
7046 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7047 sym = NULL;
7048 sec = NULL;
7049 h = NULL;
7050 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7051 warned = FALSE;
7052 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7053
7054 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7055 {
7056 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7057 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7058 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
7059
7060 relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7061 }
7062 else
7063 {
7064 bfd_boolean ignored;
7065
7066 RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
7067 r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
7068 h, sec, relocation,
7069 unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
7070
7071 sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7072 }
7073
7074 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
7075 {
7076 /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7077 or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7078 section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
7079 howto = NULL;
7080 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7081 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7082
7083 _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
7084 contents, rel->r_offset);
7085 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
7086 wrel->r_info = 0;
7087 wrel->r_addend = 0;
7088
7089 /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
7090 symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
7091 non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
7092 eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
7093 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
7094 && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
7095 wrel--;
7096
7097 continue;
7098 }
7099
7100 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7101 {
7102 if (got2 != NULL
7103 && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7104 && rel->r_addend != 0)
7105 {
7106 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
7107 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2. */
7108 rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
7109 }
7110 if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
7111 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
7112 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
7113 goto copy_reloc;
7114 }
7115
7116 /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
7117 based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
7118 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
7119 for the final instruction stream. */
7120 tls_mask = 0;
7121 tls_gd = 0;
7122 if (h != NULL)
7123 tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
7124 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
7125 {
7126 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7127 char *lgot_masks;
7128 local_plt
7129 = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7130 lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7131 tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
7132 }
7133
7134 /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
7135 if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
7136 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
7137 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
7138 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
7139 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
7140 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
7141 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
7142 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
7143 abort ();
7144 switch (r_type)
7145 {
7146 default:
7147 break;
7148
7149 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7150 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7151 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7152 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7153 {
7154 bfd_vma insn;
7155
7156 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7157 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7158 insn &= 31 << 21;
7159 insn |= 0x3c020000; /* addis 0,2,0 */
7160 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7161 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7162 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7163 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7164 }
7165 break;
7166
7167 case R_PPC_TLS:
7168 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7169 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7170 {
7171 bfd_vma insn;
7172
7173 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7174 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
7175 if (insn == 0)
7176 abort ();
7177 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7178 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7179 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7180
7181 /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
7182 PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
7183 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7184 }
7185 break;
7186
7187 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7188 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7189 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7190 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7191 goto tls_gdld_hi;
7192 break;
7193
7194 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7195 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7196 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7197 {
7198 tls_gdld_hi:
7199 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7200 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7201 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7202 else
7203 {
7204 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
7205 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7206 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7207 }
7208 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7209 }
7210 break;
7211
7212 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7213 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7214 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7215 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7216 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
7217 break;
7218
7219 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7220 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7221 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7222 {
7223 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
7224 bfd_vma offset;
7225
7226 tls_ldgd_opt:
7227 offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
7228 /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
7229 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
7230 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
7231 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
7232 the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
7233 if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr
7234 && rel + 1 < relend
7235 && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
7236 htab->tls_get_addr))
7237 offset = rel[1].r_offset;
7238 /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
7239 the destination reg. It may be something other than
7240 the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
7241 intervening code. */
7242 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7243 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7244 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7245 {
7246 /* IE */
7247 insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
7248 insn1 |= 32u << 26; /* lwz */
7249 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7250 {
7251 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7252 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7253 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7254 }
7255 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7256 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7257 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7258 }
7259 else
7260 {
7261 /* LE */
7262 insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
7263 insn1 |= 0x3c020000; /* addis r,2,0 */
7264 if (tls_gd == 0)
7265 {
7266 /* Was an LD reloc. */
7267 for (r_symndx = 0;
7268 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7269 r_symndx++)
7270 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7271 break;
7272 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7273 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7274 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7275 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7276 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7277 + sec->output_offset
7278 + sec->output_section->vma);
7279 }
7280 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7281 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7282 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7283 {
7284 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7285 rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
7286 rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
7287 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7288 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7289 }
7290 }
7291 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
7292 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7293 if (tls_gd == 0)
7294 {
7295 /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc. Start over
7296 in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
7297 goto again;
7298 }
7299 }
7300 break;
7301
7302 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7303 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7304 && rel + 1 < relend)
7305 {
7306 unsigned int insn2;
7307 bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
7308
7309 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7310 {
7311 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
7312 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7313 break;
7314 }
7315
7316 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
7317 {
7318 /* IE */
7319 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7320 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7321 }
7322 else
7323 {
7324 /* LE */
7325 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7326 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7327 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7328 }
7329 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7330 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7331 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7332 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7333 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7334 }
7335 break;
7336
7337 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7338 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7339 && rel + 1 < relend)
7340 {
7341 unsigned int insn2;
7342
7343 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7344 {
7345 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7346 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7347 break;
7348 }
7349
7350 for (r_symndx = 0;
7351 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7352 r_symndx++)
7353 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7354 break;
7355 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7356 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7357 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7358 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7359 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7360 + sec->output_offset
7361 + sec->output_section->vma);
7362
7363 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7364 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7365 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7366 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
7367 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7368 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7369 BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7370 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7371 goto again;
7372 }
7373 break;
7374 }
7375
7376 /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
7377 branch_bit = 0;
7378 switch (r_type)
7379 {
7380 default:
7381 break;
7382
7383 /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
7384 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7385 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7386 branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7387 /* Fall through. */
7388
7389 /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
7390 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7391 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7392 {
7393 unsigned int insn;
7394
7395 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7396 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7397 insn |= branch_bit;
7398
7399 from = (rel->r_offset
7400 + input_section->output_offset
7401 + input_section->output_section->vma);
7402
7403 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
7404 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
7405 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7406
7407 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7408 }
7409 break;
7410
7411 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
7412 {
7413 unsigned int insn;
7414
7415 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7416 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7417 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26
7418 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
7419 {
7420 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
7421 {
7422 /* Convert addis to lis. */
7423 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7424 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7425 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7426 }
7427 }
7428 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
7429 info->callbacks->einfo
7430 (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
7431 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7432 "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
7433 }
7434 break;
7435 }
7436
7437 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
7438 && h != NULL
7439 && !h->def_regular
7440 && h->protected_def
7441 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
7442 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
7443 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
7444 {
7445 /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
7446 variable defined in a shared library to PIC. */
7447 unsigned int insn;
7448
7449 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
7450 {
7451 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7452 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7453 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (15u << 26)
7454 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
7455 {
7456 bfd_byte *p;
7457 bfd_vma off;
7458 bfd_vma got_addr;
7459
7460 p = (contents + input_section->size
7461 - relax_info->workaround_size
7462 - relax_info->picfixup_size
7463 + picfixup_size);
7464 off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7465 if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
7466 info->callbacks->einfo
7467 (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
7468 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7469
7470 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
7471 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7472 got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7473 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7474 + (h->got.offset & ~1));
7475 wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
7476 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
7477 wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
7478 insn &= ~0xffff;
7479 insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
7480 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7481
7482 /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT. */
7483 insn &= ~0xffff;
7484 insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
7485 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
7486 insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
7487 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
7488
7489 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
7490 picfixup_size += 12;
7491
7492 /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
7493 output is reasonable. */
7494 memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
7495 wrel++, rel++;
7496 rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
7497 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
7498 rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
7499
7500 /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
7501 dynamic reloc. */
7502 r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
7503 }
7504 else
7505 _bfd_error_handler
7506 /* xgettext:c-format */
7507 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7508 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7509 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7510 "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
7511 }
7512 else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
7513 {
7514 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7515 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7516 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
7517 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7518 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7519 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7520 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7521 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7522 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7523 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7524 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7525 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7526 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7527 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7528 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7529 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7530 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
7531 && (insn & 3) != 1)
7532 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
7533 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
7534 {
7535 /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any. */
7536 relocation = 0;
7537 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7538 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
7539 }
7540 else
7541 _bfd_error_handler
7542 /* xgettext:c-format */
7543 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7544 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7545 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7546 "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
7547 }
7548 }
7549
7550 ifunc = NULL;
7551 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
7552 {
7553 struct plt_entry *ent;
7554
7555 if (h != NULL)
7556 {
7557 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7558 ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
7559 }
7560 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
7561 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7562 {
7563 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7564
7565 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
7566 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7567 ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
7568 }
7569
7570 ent = NULL;
7571 if (ifunc != NULL
7572 && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7573 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
7574 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7575 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7576 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7577 {
7578 addend = 0;
7579 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7580 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7581 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7582 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7583 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7584 addend = rel->r_addend;
7585 ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
7586 }
7587 if (ent != NULL)
7588 {
7589 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7590 && ent->sec != got2
7591 && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
7592 && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7593 || h == NULL
7594 || h->dynindx == -1))
7595 {
7596 /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
7597 for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
7598 finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
7599 apparently are using code compiled with
7600 -mbss-plt. The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
7601 gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
7602 whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
7603 is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
7604 into .got2). */
7605 info->callbacks->einfo
7606 /* xgettext:c-format */
7607 (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
7608 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
7609 }
7610
7611 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7612 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
7613 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7614 || h == NULL
7615 || h->dynindx == -1)
7616 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
7617 + htab->glink->output_offset
7618 + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
7619 else
7620 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
7621 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
7622 + ent->plt.offset);
7623 }
7624 }
7625
7626 addend = rel->r_addend;
7627 save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
7628 howto = NULL;
7629 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7630 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7631
7632 switch (r_type)
7633 {
7634 default:
7635 break;
7636
7637 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
7638 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7639 {
7640 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7641 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7642 if ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
7643 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */)
7644 /* xgettext:c-format */
7645 info->callbacks->minfo
7646 (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
7647 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, howto->name, insn);
7648 else
7649 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
7650 }
7651 break;
7652
7653 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
7654 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7655 {
7656 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7657 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7658 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7659 insn |= 2 << 16;
7660 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7661 }
7662 break;
7663 }
7664
7665 tls_type = 0;
7666 switch (r_type)
7667 {
7668 default:
7669 /* xgettext:c-format */
7670 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
7671 input_bfd, howto->name);
7672
7673 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7674 ret = FALSE;
7675 goto copy_reloc;
7676
7677 case R_PPC_NONE:
7678 case R_PPC_TLS:
7679 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7680 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7681 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
7682 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7683 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
7684 goto copy_reloc;
7685
7686 /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
7687 address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
7688 symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
7689 symbol and put the symbol value there. */
7690 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7691 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7692 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7693 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7694 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7695 goto dogot;
7696
7697 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7698 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7699 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7700 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7701 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7702 goto dogot;
7703
7704 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7705 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7706 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7707 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7708 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7709 goto dogot;
7710
7711 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
7712 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
7713 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
7714 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
7715 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7716 goto dogot;
7717
7718 case R_PPC_GOT16:
7719 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
7720 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
7721 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
7722 tls_mask = 0;
7723 dogot:
7724 {
7725 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
7726 offset table. */
7727 bfd_vma off;
7728 bfd_vma *offp;
7729 unsigned long indx;
7730
7731 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
7732 abort ();
7733
7734 indx = 0;
7735 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
7736 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7737 offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
7738 else if (h != NULL)
7739 {
7740 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7741 || h->dynindx == -1
7742 || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
7743 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7744 /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
7745 -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
7746 locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
7747 because of a version file. */
7748 ;
7749 else
7750 {
7751 indx = h->dynindx;
7752 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7753 }
7754 offp = &h->got.offset;
7755 }
7756 else
7757 {
7758 if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
7759 abort ();
7760 offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
7761 }
7762
7763 /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4. We use the
7764 least significant bit to record whether we have already
7765 processed this entry. */
7766 off = *offp;
7767 if ((off & 1) != 0)
7768 off &= ~1;
7769 else
7770 {
7771 unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7772 ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
7773 | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
7774 : 0);
7775
7776 if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7777 tls_m = TLS_LD;
7778 else if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0
7779 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7780 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7781
7782 /* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
7783 Initialize them all. */
7784 do
7785 {
7786 int tls_ty = 0;
7787
7788 if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
7789 {
7790 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7791 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7792 }
7793 else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
7794 {
7795 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7796 tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
7797 }
7798 else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7799 {
7800 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7801 tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
7802 }
7803 else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
7804 {
7805 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7806 tls_m = 0;
7807 }
7808
7809 /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker. */
7810 if (indx != 0
7811 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7812 && (h == NULL
7813 || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7814 && !(tls_ty != 0
7815 && bfd_link_executable (info)
7816 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))))
7817 {
7818 asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
7819 bfd_byte * loc;
7820
7821 if (ifunc != NULL)
7822 {
7823 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
7824 if (indx == 0)
7825 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7826 else if (is_static_defined (h))
7827 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7828 }
7829 outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7830 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7831 + off);
7832 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7833 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7834 {
7835 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
7836 if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7837 {
7838 loc = rsec->contents;
7839 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7840 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7841 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
7842 &outrel, loc);
7843 outrel.r_offset += 4;
7844 outrel.r_info
7845 = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7846 }
7847 }
7848 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7849 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7850 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
7851 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
7852 else if (indx != 0)
7853 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
7854 else if (ifunc != NULL)
7855 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
7856 else
7857 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
7858 if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7859 {
7860 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
7861 if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
7862 {
7863 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7864 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7865 else
7866 outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7867 }
7868 }
7869 loc = rsec->contents;
7870 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7871 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7872 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
7873 }
7874
7875 /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
7876 emitting a reloc. */
7877 else
7878 {
7879 bfd_vma value = relocation;
7880
7881 if (tls_ty != 0)
7882 {
7883 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7884 value = 0;
7885 else
7886 {
7887 if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
7888 value = 0;
7889 else
7890 value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7891 if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
7892 value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
7893 }
7894
7895 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7896 {
7897 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7898 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
7899 value = 1;
7900 }
7901 }
7902 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7903 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
7904 }
7905
7906 off += 4;
7907 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7908 off += 4;
7909 }
7910 while (tls_m != 0);
7911
7912 off = *offp;
7913 *offp = off | 1;
7914 }
7915
7916 if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
7917 abort ();
7918
7919 if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
7920 {
7921 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7922 {
7923 if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
7924 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7925 off += 8;
7926 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7927 {
7928 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
7929 off += 8;
7930 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7931 {
7932 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7933 off += 4;
7934 }
7935 }
7936 }
7937 }
7938
7939 /* If here for a picfixup, we're done. */
7940 if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
7941 goto copy_reloc;
7942
7943 relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7944 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7945 + off
7946 - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
7947
7948 /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
7949 x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
7950 generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
7951 got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m. */
7952 if (addend != 0)
7953 info->callbacks->einfo
7954 /* xgettext:c-format */
7955 (_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
7956 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7957 howto->name,
7958 sym_name);
7959 }
7960 break;
7961
7962 /* Relocations that need no special processing. */
7963 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
7964 /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
7965 at a symbol not in this object. */
7966 if (unresolved_reloc)
7967 {
7968 (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
7969 h->root.root.string,
7970 input_bfd,
7971 input_section,
7972 rel->r_offset,
7973 TRUE);
7974 goto copy_reloc;
7975 }
7976 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
7977 {
7978 /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
7979 the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere. More
7980 seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
7981 stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
7982 access the PLT. The problem is that a call that is
7983 local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
7984 -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
7985 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section. */
7986 /* xgettext:c-format */
7987 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
7988 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7989 h->root.root.string);
7990 }
7991 break;
7992
7993 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
7994 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
7995 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
7996 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
7997 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
7998 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7999 break;
8000
8001 /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
8002 object. */
8003 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8004 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8005 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
8006 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8007 if (h != NULL
8008 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
8009 && h->dynindx == -1)
8010 {
8011 /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
8012 resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
8013 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
8014 defined before using them. */
8015 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
8016 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8017 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
8018 if (insn != 0)
8019 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8020 break;
8021 }
8022 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8023 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8024 /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
8025 libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
8026 DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
8027 goto dodyn;
8028
8029 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
8030 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8031 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8032 goto dodyn;
8033
8034 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
8035 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8036 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8037 goto dodyn;
8038
8039 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
8040 relocation = 1;
8041 addend = 0;
8042 goto dodyn;
8043
8044 case R_PPC_REL16:
8045 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
8046 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
8047 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8048 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8049 break;
8050
8051 case R_PPC_REL32:
8052 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8053 break;
8054 /* fall through */
8055
8056 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
8057 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8058 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8059 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
8060 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8061 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
8062 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
8063 goto dodyn;
8064
8065 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
8066 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
8067 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
8068 case R_PPC_REL24:
8069 case R_PPC_REL14:
8070 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
8071 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
8072 /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
8073 handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker. */
8074 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8075 || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8076 break;
8077 /* fall through */
8078
8079 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
8080 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
8081 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
8082 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
8083 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8084 break;
8085 /* fall through */
8086
8087 dodyn:
8088 if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8089 || is_vxworks_tls)
8090 break;
8091
8092 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8093 ? ((h == NULL
8094 || ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8095 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
8096 || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
8097 : (h != NULL
8098 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL))
8099 {
8100 int skip;
8101 bfd_byte *loc;
8102 asection *sreloc;
8103 long indx = 0;
8104
8105 #ifdef DEBUG
8106 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
8107 "create relocation for %s\n",
8108 (h && h->root.root.string
8109 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
8110 #endif
8111
8112 /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
8113 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
8114 time. */
8115 skip = 0;
8116 outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
8117 input_section,
8118 rel->r_offset);
8119 if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
8120 || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
8121 skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
8122 outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
8123 + input_section->output_offset);
8124
8125 /* Optimize unaligned reloc use. */
8126 if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) != 0)
8127 || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) == 0))
8128 r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC_UADDR32;
8129 if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) != 0)
8130 || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) == 0))
8131 r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC_UADDR16;
8132
8133 if (skip)
8134 memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
8135 else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8136 {
8137 indx = h->dynindx;
8138 BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
8139 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8140 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8141 outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8142 }
8143 else
8144 {
8145 outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
8146
8147 if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
8148 {
8149 if (ifunc != NULL)
8150 {
8151 /* If we get here when building a static
8152 executable, then the libc startup function
8153 responsible for applying indirect function
8154 relocations is going to complain about
8155 the reloc type.
8156 If we get here when building a dynamic
8157 executable, it will be because we have
8158 a text relocation. The dynamic loader
8159 will set the text segment writable and
8160 non-executable to apply text relocations.
8161 So we'll segfault when trying to run the
8162 indirection function to resolve the reloc. */
8163 info->callbacks->einfo
8164 /* xgettext:c-format */
8165 (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
8166 "function %s unsupported\n"),
8167 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8168 howto->name,
8169 sym_name);
8170 ret = FALSE;
8171 }
8172 else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
8173 ;
8174 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
8175 {
8176 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8177 ret = FALSE;
8178 }
8179 else
8180 {
8181 asection *osec;
8182
8183 /* We are turning this relocation into one
8184 against a section symbol. It would be
8185 proper to subtract the symbol's value,
8186 osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
8187 but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
8188 FIXME: Why not always use a zero index? */
8189 osec = sec->output_section;
8190 if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8191 {
8192 osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
8193 indx = 0;
8194 }
8195 else
8196 {
8197 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8198 if (indx == 0)
8199 {
8200 osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
8201 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8202 }
8203 BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
8204 }
8205
8206 /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
8207 Don't leave the symbol value in the
8208 addend for them. */
8209 if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
8210 outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
8211 }
8212
8213 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8214 }
8215 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8216 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
8217 else
8218 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
8219 }
8220
8221 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
8222 if (ifunc)
8223 {
8224 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8225 if (indx == 0)
8226 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8227 else if (is_static_defined (h))
8228 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8229 }
8230 if (sreloc == NULL)
8231 return FALSE;
8232
8233 loc = sreloc->contents;
8234 loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8235 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
8236
8237 if (skip == -1)
8238 goto copy_reloc;
8239
8240 /* This reloc will be computed at runtime. Clear the memory
8241 so that it contains a predictable value for prelink. */
8242 if (!skip)
8243 {
8244 relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
8245 addend = 0;
8246 break;
8247 }
8248 }
8249 break;
8250
8251 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
8252 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
8253 if (h != NULL)
8254 {
8255 struct plt_entry *ent;
8256 bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
8257
8258 if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
8259 {
8260 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8261 got2_addend = addend;
8262 addend = 0;
8263 }
8264 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
8265 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8266 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8267 + htab->glink->output_offset
8268 + ent->glink_offset);
8269 else
8270 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8271 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8272 + ent->plt.offset);
8273 }
8274 /* Fall through. */
8275
8276 case R_PPC_RELAX:
8277 {
8278 const int *stub;
8279 size_t size;
8280 size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
8281 unsigned int insn;
8282
8283 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8284 {
8285 relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
8286 + input_section->output_offset
8287 + rel->r_offset - 4);
8288 stub = shared_stub_entry;
8289 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
8290 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
8291 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
8292 stub += 3;
8293 size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
8294 }
8295 else
8296 {
8297 stub = stub_entry;
8298 size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
8299 }
8300
8301 relocation += addend;
8302 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8303 relocation = 0;
8304
8305 /* First insn is HA, second is LO. */
8306 insn = *stub++;
8307 insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8308 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8309 insn_offset += 4;
8310
8311 insn = *stub++;
8312 insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
8313 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8314 insn_offset += 4;
8315 size -= 2;
8316
8317 while (size != 0)
8318 {
8319 insn = *stub++;
8320 --size;
8321 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8322 insn_offset += 4;
8323 }
8324
8325 /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
8326 relocs to describe this relocation. */
8327 BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
8328 /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
8329 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
8330 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
8331 wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8332 memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
8333 wrel++, rel++;
8334 wrel->r_offset += 4;
8335 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
8336 }
8337 continue;
8338
8339 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
8340 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
8341 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
8342 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
8343 {
8344 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8345 break;
8346 }
8347 relocation
8348 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
8349 h, relocation, rel);
8350 addend = 0;
8351 break;
8352
8353 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
8354 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
8355 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
8356 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
8357 {
8358 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8359 break;
8360 }
8361 relocation
8362 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
8363 h, relocation, rel);
8364 addend = 0;
8365 break;
8366
8367 /* Handle the TOC16 reloc. We want to use the offset within the .got
8368 section, not the actual VMA. This is appropriate when generating
8369 an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
8370 AIX .toc section. */
8371 case R_PPC_TOC16: /* phony GOT16 relocations */
8372 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8373 {
8374 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8375 break;
8376 }
8377 BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".got") == 0
8378 || strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".cgot") == 0);
8379
8380 addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
8381 break;
8382
8383 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
8384 if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
8385 {
8386 struct plt_entry *ent;
8387
8388 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
8389 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8390 if (ent == NULL
8391 || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
8392 {
8393 /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol. This
8394 happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
8395 using -Bsymbolic. */
8396 }
8397 else
8398 {
8399 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
8400 procedure linkage table. */
8401 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8402 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8403 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8404 + htab->glink->output_offset
8405 + ent->glink_offset);
8406 else
8407 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8408 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8409 + ent->plt.offset);
8410 }
8411 }
8412
8413 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
8414 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
8415 Don't apply it to the relocation field. */
8416 addend = 0;
8417 break;
8418
8419 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8420 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8421 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8422 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
8423 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8424 plt_list = NULL;
8425 if (h != NULL)
8426 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
8427 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8428 plt_list = ifunc;
8429 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
8430 {
8431 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
8432 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
8433 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
8434 plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
8435 }
8436 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8437 if (plt_list != NULL)
8438 {
8439 struct plt_entry *ent;
8440
8441 ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
8442 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8443 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8444 {
8445 asection *plt;
8446
8447 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8448 plt = htab->elf.splt;
8449 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
8450 || h == NULL
8451 || h->dynindx == -1)
8452 {
8453 if (ifunc != NULL)
8454 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
8455 else
8456 plt = htab->pltlocal;
8457 }
8458 relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
8459 + plt->output_offset
8460 + ent->plt.offset);
8461 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8462 {
8463 bfd_vma got = 0;
8464
8465 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
8466 got = (ent->addend
8467 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
8468 + ent->sec->output_offset);
8469 else
8470 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
8471 relocation -= got;
8472 }
8473 }
8474 }
8475 addend = 0;
8476 break;
8477
8478 /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_. */
8479 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8480 {
8481 const char *name;
8482 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8483
8484 if (sec == NULL
8485 || sec->output_section == NULL
8486 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8487 {
8488 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8489 break;
8490 }
8491 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8492
8493 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8494 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8495 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
8496 {
8497 _bfd_error_handler
8498 /* xgettext:c-format */
8499 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8500 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8501 input_bfd,
8502 sym_name,
8503 howto->name,
8504 name);
8505 }
8506 }
8507 break;
8508
8509 /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_. */
8510 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
8511 {
8512 const char *name;
8513 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8514
8515 if (sec == NULL
8516 || sec->output_section == NULL
8517 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8518 {
8519 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8520 break;
8521 }
8522 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8523
8524 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8525 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8526 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
8527 {
8528 _bfd_error_handler
8529 /* xgettext:c-format */
8530 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8531 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8532 input_bfd,
8533 sym_name,
8534 howto->name,
8535 name);
8536 }
8537 }
8538 break;
8539
8540 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
8541 relocation = relocation + addend;
8542 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8543 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8544 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8545 goto copy_reloc;
8546
8547 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
8548 relocation = relocation + addend;
8549 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8550 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8551 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8552 goto copy_reloc;
8553
8554 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
8555 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8556 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8557 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8558 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8559 goto copy_reloc;
8560
8561 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
8562 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8563 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8564 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8565 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8566 goto copy_reloc;
8567
8568 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
8569 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8570 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8571 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8572 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8573 goto copy_reloc;
8574
8575 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
8576 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8577 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8578 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8579 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8580 goto copy_reloc;
8581
8582 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0. */
8583 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
8584 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
8585 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
8586 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
8587 {
8588 const char *name;
8589 int reg;
8590 unsigned int insn;
8591 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8592
8593 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8594 {
8595 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8596 break;
8597 }
8598
8599 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8600 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8601 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8602 {
8603 reg = 13;
8604 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8605 }
8606 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8607 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8608 {
8609 reg = 2;
8610 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8611 }
8612 else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
8613 || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
8614 {
8615 reg = 0;
8616 }
8617 else
8618 {
8619 _bfd_error_handler
8620 /* xgettext:c-format */
8621 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8622 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8623 input_bfd,
8624 sym_name,
8625 howto->name,
8626 name);
8627
8628 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8629 ret = FALSE;
8630 goto copy_reloc;
8631 }
8632
8633 if (sda != NULL)
8634 {
8635 if (!is_static_defined (sda))
8636 {
8637 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8638 break;
8639 }
8640 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8641 }
8642
8643 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
8644 break;
8645
8646 /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
8647 version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
8648 operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset. GNU as and
8649 GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
8650 a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset. Cope with object file
8651 producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
8652 generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects. */
8653 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
8654 rel->r_offset &= ~1;
8655
8656 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8657 if (reg == 0
8658 && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8659 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
8660 {
8661 relocation = relocation + addend;
8662 addend = 0;
8663
8664 /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn. */
8665 insn &= 0x1f << 21;
8666 insn |= 28u << 26;
8667
8668 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
8669 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
8670 insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
8671 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
8672 insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
8673 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
8674 insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
8675
8676 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8677
8678 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8679 && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
8680 goto overflow;
8681 goto copy_reloc;
8682 }
8683 /* Fill in register field. */
8684 insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
8685 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8686 }
8687 break;
8688
8689 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
8690 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
8691 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
8692 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
8693 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
8694 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
8695 {
8696 bfd_vma value;
8697 const char *name;
8698 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8699
8700 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8701 {
8702 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8703 break;
8704 }
8705
8706 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8707 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8708 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8709 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8710 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8711 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8712 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8713 else
8714 {
8715 _bfd_error_handler
8716 /* xgettext:c-format */
8717 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8718 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8719 input_bfd,
8720 sym_name,
8721 howto->name,
8722 name);
8723
8724 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8725 ret = FALSE;
8726 goto copy_reloc;
8727 }
8728
8729 if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
8730 {
8731 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8732 break;
8733 }
8734 value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
8735
8736 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
8737 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8738 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8739 split16a_type,
8740 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8741 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
8742 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8743 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8744 split16d_type,
8745 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8746 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
8747 {
8748 value = value >> 16;
8749 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8750 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8751 split16a_type,
8752 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8753 }
8754 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
8755 {
8756 value = value >> 16;
8757 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8758 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8759 split16d_type,
8760 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8761 }
8762 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
8763 {
8764 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8765 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8766 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8767 split16a_type,
8768 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8769 }
8770 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
8771 {
8772 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8773 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8774 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8775 split16d_type,
8776 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8777 }
8778 }
8779 goto copy_reloc;
8780
8781 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
8782 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset, relocation);
8783 continue;
8784
8785 /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
8786 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8787 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8788 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
8789 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8790 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8791 {
8792 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8793 break;
8794 }
8795 addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
8796 break;
8797
8798 /* Negative relocations. */
8799 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
8800 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
8801 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
8802 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
8803 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8804 addend -= 2 * relocation;
8805 break;
8806
8807 case R_PPC_COPY:
8808 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
8809 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
8810 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
8811 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
8812 case R_PPC_PLT32:
8813 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
8814 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
8815 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
8816 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
8817 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
8818 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8819 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
8820 /* xgettext:c-format */
8821 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8822 input_bfd, howto->name);
8823
8824 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8825 ret = FALSE;
8826 goto copy_reloc;
8827 }
8828
8829 switch (r_type)
8830 {
8831 default:
8832 break;
8833
8834 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8835 if (unresolved_reloc)
8836 {
8837 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
8838 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8839 insn &= 1;
8840 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
8841 unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
8842 r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
8843 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8844 }
8845 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8846 info->callbacks->einfo
8847 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8848 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8849 howto->name);
8850 break;
8851
8852 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8853 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8854 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8855 if (unresolved_reloc)
8856 {
8857 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8858 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8859 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8860 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
8861 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8862 }
8863 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8864 info->callbacks->einfo
8865 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8866 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8867 howto->name);
8868 break;
8869 }
8870
8871 /* Do any further special processing. */
8872 switch (r_type)
8873 {
8874 default:
8875 break;
8876
8877 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8878 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8879 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8880 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8881 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8882 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8883 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8884 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8885 /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
8886 that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
8887 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
8888 alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
8889 if (sec == NULL)
8890 break;
8891 /* Fall through. */
8892
8893 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8894 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
8895 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8896 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8897 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8898 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8899 /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
8900 Bits 0:15 are not used. */
8901 addend += 0x8000;
8902 break;
8903
8904 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8905 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8906 case R_PPC_GOT16:
8907 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
8908 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8909 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8910 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8911 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8912 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8913 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8914 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8915 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
8916 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8917 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
8918 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8919 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
8920 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
8921 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
8922 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
8923 {
8924 /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
8925 certain 64-bit instructions. Prevent damage to bits
8926 that make up part of the insn opcode. */
8927 unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
8928
8929 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
8930 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
8931 mask = 0;
8932 if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
8933 mask = 3;
8934 else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
8935 mask = 15;
8936 else
8937 break;
8938 relocation += addend;
8939 addend = insn & mask;
8940 lobit = mask & relocation;
8941 if (lobit != 0)
8942 {
8943 relocation ^= lobit;
8944 info->callbacks->einfo
8945 /* xgettext:c-format */
8946 (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
8947 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8948 howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
8949 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8950 ret = FALSE;
8951 }
8952 }
8953 break;
8954 }
8955
8956 #ifdef DEBUG
8957 fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
8958 "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
8959 howto->name,
8960 (int) r_type,
8961 sym_name,
8962 r_symndx,
8963 (long) rel->r_offset,
8964 (long) addend);
8965 #endif
8966
8967 if (unresolved_reloc
8968 && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
8969 && h->def_dynamic)
8970 && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
8971 rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
8972 {
8973 info->callbacks->einfo
8974 /* xgettext:c-format */
8975 (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
8976 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8977 howto->name,
8978 sym_name);
8979 ret = FALSE;
8980 }
8981
8982 /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
8983 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
8984 have different reloc types. */
8985 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
8986 && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
8987 && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
8988 {
8989 enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
8990
8991 if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
8992 {
8993 unsigned int insn;
8994
8995 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
8996 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
8997 complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
8998 else if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
8999 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
9000 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
9001 complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
9002 }
9003 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
9004 {
9005 alt_howto = *howto;
9006 alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
9007 howto = &alt_howto;
9008 }
9009 }
9010
9011 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
9012 {
9013 /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
9014 if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
9015 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
9016 else
9017 {
9018 unsigned int insn;
9019
9020 relocation += addend;
9021 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
9022 + input_section->output_offset
9023 + input_section->output_section->vma);
9024 relocation >>= 16;
9025 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
9026 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
9027 insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
9028 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
9029 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
9030 }
9031 }
9032 else
9033 r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
9034 rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
9035
9036 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
9037 {
9038 if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
9039 {
9040 overflow:
9041 /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
9042 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
9043 if (!warned
9044 && !(h != NULL
9045 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
9046 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9047 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
9048 info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
9049 (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
9050 rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9051 }
9052 else
9053 {
9054 info->callbacks->einfo
9055 /* xgettext:c-format */
9056 (_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
9057 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9058 howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
9059 ret = FALSE;
9060 }
9061 }
9062 copy_reloc:
9063 if (wrel != rel)
9064 *wrel = *rel;
9065 }
9066
9067 if (wrel != rel)
9068 {
9069 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9070 size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
9071
9072 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
9073 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9074 if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
9075 {
9076 /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
9077 one NONE reloc.
9078 ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
9079 rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9080 deleted -= 1;
9081 wrel++;
9082 }
9083 relend = wrel;
9084 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
9085 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9086 input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
9087 }
9088
9089 #ifdef DEBUG
9090 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9091 #endif
9092
9093 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9094 && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
9095 && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
9096 || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
9097 {
9098 /* Branch around the trampolines. */
9099 unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
9100 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
9101 }
9102
9103 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
9104 && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9105 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9106 || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
9107 >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
9108 {
9109 bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
9110 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
9111
9112 if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
9113 {
9114 bfd_byte *p;
9115 unsigned int n;
9116 bfd_byte fill[4];
9117
9118 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
9119 p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
9120 n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
9121 while (n--)
9122 {
9123 memcpy (p, fill, 4);
9124 p += 4;
9125 }
9126 }
9127
9128 /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
9129 branch to a patch area. Put the insn there followed by a
9130 branch back to the next page. Complicated a little by
9131 needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
9132 wanting to touch data-in-text. */
9133
9134 start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
9135 + input_section->output_offset);
9136 end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9137 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9138 for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
9139 addr < end_addr;
9140 addr += pagesize)
9141 {
9142 bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
9143 Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
9144 bfd_boolean is_data;
9145 bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
9146 unsigned int insn;
9147
9148 /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset? If so, leave
9149 the word alone. */
9150 is_data = FALSE;
9151 lo = relocs;
9152 hi = relend;
9153 rel = NULL;
9154 while (lo < hi)
9155 {
9156 rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
9157 if (rel->r_offset < offset)
9158 lo = rel + 1;
9159 else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
9160 hi = rel;
9161 else
9162 {
9163 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
9164 {
9165 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
9166 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
9167 case R_PPC_REL32:
9168 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
9169 is_data = TRUE;
9170 break;
9171 default:
9172 break;
9173 }
9174 break;
9175 }
9176 }
9177 if (is_data)
9178 continue;
9179
9180 /* Some instructions can be left alone too. Unconditional
9181 branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
9182 avoid the icache failure.
9183
9184 The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
9185 where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
9186 page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
9187 instructions fails under certain circumstances. The
9188 unconditional branches:
9189 1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
9190 2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
9191 3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
9192 where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
9193 prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
9194 affected by these instructions. This happens even if the
9195 instruction is not executed.
9196
9197 A bctr example:
9198 .
9199 . lis 9,new_page@ha
9200 . addi 9,9,new_page@l
9201 . mtctr 9
9202 . bctr
9203 . nop
9204 . nop
9205 . new_page:
9206 .
9207 The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
9208 ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
9209 new page which might have stale instructions. If they
9210 fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
9211 bctr executes. Either of the following modifications
9212 prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
9213 place:
9214 .
9215 . lis 9,new_page@ha lis 9,new_page@ha
9216 . addi 9,9,new_page@l addi 9,9,new_page@l
9217 . mtctr 9 mtctr 9
9218 . bctr bctr
9219 . nop b somewhere_else
9220 . b somewhere_else nop
9221 . new_page: new_page:
9222 . */
9223 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
9224 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (18u << 26) /* b,bl,ba,bla */
9225 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
9226 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /* with BO=0x14 */
9227 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (19u << 26)
9228 && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1) /* bclr,bclrl */
9229 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/* with BO=0x14 */
9230 continue;
9231
9232 patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9233 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9234 patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
9235 patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
9236 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
9237
9238 if (rel != NULL
9239 && rel->r_offset >= offset
9240 && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
9241 {
9242 asection *sreloc;
9243
9244 /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
9245 reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
9246 location. This matters for -r and --emit-relocs. */
9247 if (rel + 1 != relend)
9248 {
9249 Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
9250
9251 /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset. */
9252 memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
9253 relend[-1] = tmp;
9254 }
9255 relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9256
9257 /* Adjust REL16 addends too. */
9258 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
9259 {
9260 case R_PPC_REL16:
9261 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
9262 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
9263 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
9264 relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
9265 break;
9266 default:
9267 break;
9268 }
9269
9270 /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
9271 non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
9272 If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn. */
9273 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
9274 if (sreloc != NULL)
9275 {
9276 Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
9277 bfd_vma soffset;
9278
9279 slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
9280 shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
9281 soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
9282 + input_section->output_offset);
9283 while (slo < shi)
9284 {
9285 Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
9286 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
9287 &outrel);
9288 if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
9289 slo = srel + 1;
9290 else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
9291 shi = srel;
9292 else
9293 {
9294 if (srel + 1 != srelend)
9295 {
9296 memmove (srel, srel + 1,
9297 (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
9298 srel = srelend - 1;
9299 }
9300 outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9301 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
9302 (bfd_byte *) srel);
9303 break;
9304 }
9305 }
9306 }
9307 }
9308 else
9309 rel = NULL;
9310
9311 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
9312 && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
9313 {
9314 bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
9315
9316 delta += offset - patch_off;
9317 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9318 delta = 0;
9319 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9320 {
9321 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
9322
9323 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
9324 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
9325 insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9326 else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9327 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9328 else
9329 BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
9330
9331 if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
9332 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9333 && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
9334 && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
9335 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9336 }
9337 if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9338 {
9339 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9340 (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
9341 contents + patch_off);
9342 patch_off += 4;
9343 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9344 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9345 contents + patch_off);
9346 patch_off += 4;
9347 }
9348 else
9349 {
9350 if (rel != NULL)
9351 {
9352 unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
9353
9354 relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
9355 relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
9356 }
9357 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9358 (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
9359 contents + patch_off);
9360 patch_off += 4;
9361 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9362 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9363 contents + patch_off);
9364 patch_off += 4;
9365 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9366 B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
9367 contents + patch_off);
9368 patch_off += 4;
9369 }
9370 }
9371 else
9372 {
9373 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
9374 patch_off += 4;
9375 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9376 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9377 contents + patch_off);
9378 patch_off += 4;
9379 }
9380 BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
9381 relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
9382 }
9383 }
9384
9385 return ret;
9386 }
9387 \f
9388 /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H. */
9389
9390 static bfd_boolean
9391 write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9392 {
9393 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9394 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9395 struct plt_entry *ent;
9396 bfd_boolean doneone;
9397
9398 doneone = FALSE;
9399 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9400 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9401 {
9402 if (!doneone)
9403 {
9404 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9405 bfd_byte *loc;
9406 bfd_vma reloc_index;
9407 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9408 asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
9409
9410 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9411 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9412 || h->dynindx == -1)
9413 reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
9414 else
9415 {
9416 reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
9417 / htab->plt_slot_size);
9418 if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
9419 && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9420 reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
9421 }
9422
9423 /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
9424 Set it up. */
9425 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS
9426 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9427 && h->dynindx != -1)
9428 {
9429 bfd_vma got_offset;
9430 const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9431
9432 /* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved. */
9433 got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
9434
9435 /* Use the right PLT. */
9436 plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
9437 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
9438
9439 /* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks. */
9440 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9441 {
9442 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9443 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
9444 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9445 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9446 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
9447 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9448 }
9449 else
9450 {
9451 bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9452
9453 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9454 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
9455 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9456 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9457 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
9458 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9459 }
9460
9461 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
9462 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
9463 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
9464 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
9465
9466 /* This instruction is an immediate load. The value loaded is
9467 the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
9468 start of the .rela.plt section. The value is stored in the
9469 low-order 16 bits of the load instruction. */
9470 /* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
9471 prescaled offset. */
9472 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9473 plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
9474 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
9475 /* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
9476 the start of the PLT section. The address of this branch
9477 instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
9478 The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive. The value
9479 stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
9480 offset. */
9481 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9482 (plt_entry[5]
9483 | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
9484 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
9485 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
9486 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
9487 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
9488 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
9489
9490 /* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
9491 the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
9492 in this PLT entry. */
9493 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
9494 + plt->output_offset
9495 + ent->plt.offset + 16),
9496 htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
9497
9498 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9499 {
9500 /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded. */
9501 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
9502 + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
9503 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
9504 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9505
9506 /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
9507 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9508 + plt->output_offset
9509 + ent->plt.offset + 2);
9510 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9511 R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9512 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9513 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9514 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9515
9516 /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
9517 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9518 + plt->output_offset
9519 + ent->plt.offset + 6);
9520 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9521 R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9522 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9523 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9524 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9525
9526 /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
9527 PLT slot. Point it at the middle of the .plt entry. */
9528 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9529 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9530 + got_offset);
9531 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
9532 R_PPC_ADDR32);
9533 rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
9534 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9535 }
9536
9537 /* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
9538 In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
9539 address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
9540 by the ABI. Instead, the offset is set to the address of
9541 the GOT slot for this function. See EABI 4.4.4.1. */
9542 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9543 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9544 + got_offset);
9545 rela.r_addend = 0;
9546 }
9547 else
9548 {
9549 rela.r_addend = 0;
9550 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9551 || h->dynindx == -1)
9552 {
9553 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9554 {
9555 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9556 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9557 }
9558 else
9559 {
9560 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9561 relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9562 }
9563 if (h->def_regular
9564 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9565 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
9566 rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
9567 }
9568
9569 if (relplt == NULL)
9570 {
9571 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9572 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
9573 }
9574 else
9575 {
9576 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9577 + plt->output_offset
9578 + ent->plt.offset);
9579
9580 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
9581 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9582 || h->dynindx == -1)
9583 {
9584 /* We don't need to fill in the .plt. The ppc dynamic
9585 linker will fill it in. */
9586 }
9587 else
9588 {
9589 bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
9590 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
9591 + htab->glink->output_offset);
9592 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
9593 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
9594 }
9595 }
9596 }
9597
9598 if (relplt != NULL)
9599 {
9600 /* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9601 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9602 || h->dynindx == -1)
9603 {
9604 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9605 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9606 else
9607 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9608 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9609 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9610 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9611 }
9612 else
9613 {
9614 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
9615 loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
9616 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9617 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
9618 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9619 }
9620 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9621 }
9622 doneone = TRUE;
9623 }
9624
9625 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9626 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9627 || h->dynindx == -1)
9628 {
9629 unsigned char *p;
9630 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9631
9632 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9633 || h->dynindx == -1)
9634 {
9635 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9636 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9637 else
9638 break;
9639 }
9640
9641 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9642 write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
9643
9644 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9645 /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub. */
9646 break;
9647 }
9648 else
9649 break;
9650 }
9651 return TRUE;
9652 }
9653
9654 /* Finish up PLT handling. */
9655
9656 bfd_boolean
9657 ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9658 {
9659 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9660 bfd *ibfd;
9661
9662 if (!htab)
9663 return TRUE;
9664
9665 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
9666
9667 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9668 {
9669 bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
9670 struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
9671 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9672 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9673 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
9674 struct plt_entry *ent;
9675
9676 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
9677 continue;
9678
9679 local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
9680 if (!local_got)
9681 continue;
9682
9683 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9684 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9685 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
9686 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
9687 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9688 for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
9689 for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9690 {
9691 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9692 {
9693 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9694 asection *sym_sec;
9695 asection *plt, *relplt;
9696 bfd_byte *loc;
9697 bfd_vma val;
9698 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9699 unsigned char *p;
9700
9701 if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9702 lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
9703 {
9704 if (local_syms != NULL
9705 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9706 free (local_syms);
9707 return FALSE;
9708 }
9709
9710 val = sym->st_value;
9711 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
9712 val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
9713
9714 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9715 {
9716 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9717 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9718 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9719 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9720 }
9721 else
9722 {
9723 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9724 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9725 {
9726 relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
9727 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9728 }
9729 else
9730 {
9731 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9732 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
9733 continue;
9734 }
9735 }
9736
9737 rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
9738 + plt->output_offset
9739 + plt->output_section->vma);
9740 rela.r_addend = val;
9741 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9742 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9743 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9744
9745 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9746 write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
9747 }
9748 }
9749
9750 if (local_syms != NULL
9751 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9752 {
9753 if (!info->keep_memory)
9754 free (local_syms);
9755 else
9756 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9757 }
9758 }
9759 return TRUE;
9760 }
9761
9762 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
9763 dynamic sections here. */
9764
9765 static bfd_boolean
9766 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9767 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9768 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9769 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9770 {
9771 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9772 struct plt_entry *ent;
9773
9774 #ifdef DEBUG
9775 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
9776 h->root.root.string);
9777 #endif
9778
9779 if (!h->def_regular
9780 || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
9781 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9782 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9783 {
9784 if (!h->def_regular)
9785 {
9786 /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
9787 defined in the .plt section. Leave the value if
9788 there were any relocations where pointer equality
9789 matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
9790 make function pointer comparisons work between an
9791 application and shared library), otherwise set it
9792 to zero. */
9793 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9794 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9795 sym->st_value = 0;
9796 else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
9797 {
9798 /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
9799 that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
9800 function pointer. */
9801 sym->st_value = 0;
9802 }
9803 }
9804 else
9805 {
9806 /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
9807 executable to the glink entry. This is to avoid
9808 text relocations. We can't do this for ifunc in
9809 allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
9810 function symbols with plt entries, because we need
9811 to keep the original value around for the ifunc
9812 relocation. */
9813 sym->st_shndx
9814 = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
9815 (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
9816 sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
9817 + htab->glink->output_offset
9818 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9819 }
9820 break;
9821 }
9822
9823 if (h->needs_copy)
9824 {
9825 asection *s;
9826 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9827 bfd_byte *loc;
9828
9829 /* This symbols needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
9830
9831 #ifdef DEBUG
9832 fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
9833 #endif
9834
9835 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9836
9837 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
9838 s = htab->relsbss;
9839 else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9840 s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
9841 else
9842 s = htab->elf.srelbss;
9843 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9844
9845 rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
9846 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
9847 rela.r_addend = 0;
9848 loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9849 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9850 }
9851
9852 #ifdef DEBUG
9853 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9854 #endif
9855
9856 return TRUE;
9857 }
9858 \f
9859 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
9860 ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
9861 const asection *rel_sec,
9862 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
9863 {
9864 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9865
9866 if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
9867 return reloc_class_ifunc;
9868
9869 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
9870 {
9871 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
9872 return reloc_class_relative;
9873 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
9874 return reloc_class_plt;
9875 case R_PPC_COPY:
9876 return reloc_class_copy;
9877 default:
9878 return reloc_class_normal;
9879 }
9880 }
9881 \f
9882 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
9883
9884 static bfd_boolean
9885 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9886 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9887 {
9888 asection *sdyn;
9889 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9890 bfd_vma got;
9891 bfd *dynobj;
9892 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
9893
9894 #ifdef DEBUG
9895 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
9896 #endif
9897
9898 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9899 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9900 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9901
9902 got = 0;
9903 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
9904 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9905
9906 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9907 {
9908 Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
9909
9910 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
9911
9912 dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
9913 dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
9914 for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
9915 {
9916 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
9917 asection *s;
9918
9919 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
9920
9921 switch (dyn.d_tag)
9922 {
9923 case DT_PLTGOT:
9924 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9925 s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
9926 else
9927 s = htab->elf.splt;
9928 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9929 break;
9930
9931 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
9932 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
9933 break;
9934
9935 case DT_JMPREL:
9936 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9937 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9938 break;
9939
9940 case DT_PPC_GOT:
9941 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
9942 break;
9943
9944 case DT_TEXTREL:
9945 if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
9946 info->callbacks->einfo
9947 (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9948 "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9949 else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
9950 info->callbacks->einfo
9951 (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9952 "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9953 continue;
9954
9955 default:
9956 if (htab->is_vxworks
9957 && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
9958 break;
9959 continue;
9960 }
9961
9962 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
9963 }
9964 }
9965
9966 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
9967 && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
9968 {
9969 if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
9970 || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
9971 {
9972 unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
9973
9974 p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
9975 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9976 {
9977 /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
9978 so that a function can easily find the address of
9979 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
9980 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
9981 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
9982 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
9983 }
9984
9985 if (sdyn != NULL)
9986 {
9987 bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
9988 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
9989 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
9990 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
9991 }
9992 }
9993 else
9994 {
9995 /* xgettext:c-format */
9996 _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
9997 htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
9998 (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
9999 ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
10000 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
10001 ret = FALSE;
10002 }
10003
10004 elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
10005 }
10006
10007 /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table. */
10008 if (htab->is_vxworks
10009 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
10010 && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
10011 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10012 {
10013 asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
10014 /* Use the right PLT. */
10015 const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
10016 ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
10017 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
10018
10019 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
10020 {
10021 bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
10022
10023 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
10024 splt->contents + 0);
10025 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
10026 splt->contents + 4);
10027 }
10028 else
10029 {
10030 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents + 0);
10031 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents + 4);
10032 }
10033 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents + 8);
10034 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
10035 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
10036 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
10037 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
10038 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
10039
10040 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
10041 {
10042 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10043 bfd_byte *loc;
10044
10045 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10046
10047 /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
10048 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10049 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10050 + 2);
10051 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10052 rela.r_addend = 0;
10053 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10054 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10055
10056 /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
10057 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10058 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10059 + 6);
10060 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10061 rela.r_addend = 0;
10062 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10063 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10064
10065 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
10066 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10067 in which symbols were output. */
10068 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10069 {
10070 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10071
10072 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10073 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10074 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10075 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10076
10077 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10078 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10079 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10080 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10081
10082 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10083 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
10084 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10085 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10086 }
10087 }
10088 }
10089
10090 if (htab->glink != NULL
10091 && htab->glink->contents != NULL
10092 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10093 {
10094 unsigned char *p;
10095 unsigned char *endp;
10096 bfd_vma res0;
10097
10098 /*
10099 * PIC glink code is the following:
10100 *
10101 * # ith PLT code stub.
10102 * addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
10103 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
10104 * mtctr 11
10105 * bctr
10106 *
10107 * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
10108 * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
10109 * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
10110 * res_0: b PLTresolve
10111 * res_1: b PLTresolve
10112 * .
10113 * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
10114 * res_n_m3: nop
10115 * res_n_m2: nop
10116 * res_n_m1:
10117 *
10118 * PLTresolve:
10119 * addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
10120 * mflr 0
10121 * bcl 20,31,1f
10122 * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
10123 * mflr 12
10124 * mtlr 0
10125 * sub 11,11,12 # r11 = index * 4
10126 * addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
10127 * lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10128 * lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10129 * mtctr 0
10130 * add 0,11,11
10131 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10132 * bctr
10133 *
10134 * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
10135 *
10136 * # ith PLT code stub.
10137 * lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
10138 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
10139 * mtctr 11
10140 * bctr
10141 *
10142 * The branch table is the same, then comes
10143 *
10144 * PLTresolve:
10145 * lis 12,(got+4)@ha
10146 * addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
10147 * lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10148 * addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l # r11 = index * 4
10149 * mtctr 0
10150 * add 0,11,11
10151 * lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10152 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10153 * bctr
10154 */
10155
10156 /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
10157 and perhaps some padding. */
10158 p = htab->glink->contents;
10159 p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
10160 endp = htab->glink->contents;
10161 endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10162 while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
10163 {
10164 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
10165 p += 4;
10166 }
10167 while (p < endp)
10168 {
10169 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
10170 p += 4;
10171 }
10172
10173 res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
10174 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10175 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10176
10177 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
10178 {
10179 /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
10180 result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
10181 glink branch table. */
10182 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
10183 bfd_vma page_addr;
10184 bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10185 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10186
10187 for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
10188 page_addr > glink_start;
10189 page_addr -= pagesize)
10190 {
10191 /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing. */
10192 bfd_byte *loc;
10193 unsigned int insn;
10194
10195 loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
10196 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
10197 if (insn == BCTR)
10198 {
10199 /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
10200 one other call stub before this one. */
10201 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
10202 if (insn == BCTR)
10203 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10204 else
10205 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10206 }
10207 }
10208 }
10209
10210 /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub. */
10211 endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10212 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10213 {
10214 bfd_vma bcl;
10215
10216 bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
10217 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10218 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10219
10220 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
10221 p += 4;
10222 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
10223 p += 4;
10224 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10225 p += 4;
10226 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
10227 p += 4;
10228 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
10229 p += 4;
10230 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
10231 p += 4;
10232 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
10233 p += 4;
10234 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10235 p += 4;
10236 if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
10237 {
10238 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10239 p += 4;
10240 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
10241 p += 4;
10242 }
10243 else
10244 {
10245 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10246 p += 4;
10247 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10248 p += 4;
10249 }
10250 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10251 p += 4;
10252 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10253 }
10254 else
10255 {
10256 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
10257 p += 4;
10258 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
10259 p += 4;
10260 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10261 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10262 else
10263 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10264 p += 4;
10265 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
10266 p += 4;
10267 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10268 p += 4;
10269 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10270 p += 4;
10271 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10272 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
10273 else
10274 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10275 }
10276 p += 4;
10277 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
10278 p += 4;
10279 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
10280 p += 4;
10281 while (p < endp)
10282 {
10283 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
10284 htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
10285 p += 4;
10286 }
10287 BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
10288 }
10289
10290 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10291 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
10292 {
10293 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10294 bfd_vma val;
10295
10296 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
10297 /* FDE length. */
10298 p += 4;
10299 /* CIE pointer. */
10300 p += 4;
10301 /* Offset to .glink. */
10302 val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10303 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10304 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
10305 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
10306 val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10307 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
10308
10309 if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
10310 && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
10311 htab->glink_eh_frame,
10312 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
10313 return FALSE;
10314 }
10315
10316 return ret;
10317 }
10318 \f
10319 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf32_le_vec
10320 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-powerpcle"
10321 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vec
10322 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc"
10323 #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
10324 #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC32_ELF_DATA
10325 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC
10326 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
10327 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
10328 #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
10329 #define elf_info_to_howto ppc_elf_info_to_howto
10330
10331 #ifdef EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10332 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1 EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10333 #endif
10334
10335 #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
10336 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2 EM_PPC_OLD
10337 #endif
10338
10339 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
10340 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
10341 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
10342 #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
10343 #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
10344 #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize 1
10345
10346 #define bfd_elf32_mkobject ppc_elf_mkobject
10347 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
10348 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section ppc_elf_relax_section
10349 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
10350 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
10351 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags ppc_elf_set_private_flags
10352 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
10353 #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
10354
10355 #define elf_backend_object_p ppc_elf_object_p
10356 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
10357 #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
10358 #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc_elf_relocate_section
10359 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
10360 #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc_elf_check_relocs
10361 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
10362 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
10363 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10364 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
10365 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
10366 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc_elf_hash_symbol
10367 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
10368 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
10369 #define elf_backend_fake_sections ppc_elf_fake_sections
10370 #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
10371 #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
10372 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
10373 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
10374 #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc_elf_write_core_note
10375 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
10376 #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
10377 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing ppc_elf_final_write_processing
10378 #define elf_backend_write_section ppc_elf_write_section
10379 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
10380 #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
10381 #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc_elf_action_discarded
10382 #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
10383 #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
10384
10385 #include "elf32-target.h"
10386
10387 /* FreeBSD Target */
10388
10389 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10390 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10391
10392 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10393 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
10394 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10395 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
10396
10397 #undef ELF_OSABI
10398 #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
10399
10400 #undef elf32_bed
10401 #define elf32_bed elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
10402
10403 #include "elf32-target.h"
10404
10405 /* VxWorks Target */
10406
10407 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10408 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10409
10410 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10411 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
10412 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10413 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
10414
10415 #undef ELF_OSABI
10416
10417 /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt. */
10418 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
10419 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10420 {
10421 if (sec->name == NULL)
10422 return NULL;
10423
10424 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
10425 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10426
10427 return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10428 }
10429
10430 /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
10431 appropriately for VxWorks. */
10432 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
10433 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10434 {
10435 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10436
10437 ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10438 if (ret)
10439 {
10440 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
10441 = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
10442 htab->is_vxworks = 1;
10443 htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
10444 htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10445 htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10446 htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
10447 }
10448 return ret;
10449 }
10450
10451 /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded. */
10452 static bfd_boolean
10453 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
10454 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10455 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10456 const char **namep,
10457 flagword *flagsp,
10458 asection **secp,
10459 bfd_vma *valp)
10460 {
10461 if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
10462 valp))
10463 return FALSE;
10464
10465 return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
10466 }
10467
10468 static bfd_boolean
10469 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
10470 {
10471 ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
10472 return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd);
10473 }
10474
10475 /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
10476 define it. */
10477 #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
10478 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 1
10479 #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
10480 #define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1
10481 #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
10482 #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset 0
10483 #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
10484 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 0
10485 #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
10486 #define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1
10487 #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
10488 #define elf_backend_got_header_size 12
10489 #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
10490 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
10491
10492 #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
10493
10494 #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
10495 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
10496 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
10497 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
10498 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
10499 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
10500 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
10501 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
10502 elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
10503 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
10504 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
10505 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
10506 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
10507 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
10508 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
10509 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
10510 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
10511 elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
10512
10513 #undef elf32_bed
10514 #define elf32_bed ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
10515
10516 #include "elf32-target.h"
This page took 0.355713 seconds and 3 git commands to generate.